auto upstream
[emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
blobd1934b1986eef55ebf4e797edfc224f7d48e73dc
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
3 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993-2013 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
21 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
23 #include <config.h>
24 #include <stdio.h>
26 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
28 #include "lisp.h"
29 #include "blockinput.h"
30 #include "syssignal.h"
32 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
33 if this is not done before the other system files. */
34 #include "xterm.h"
35 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
37 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
38 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
39 #ifndef makedev
40 #include <sys/types.h>
41 #endif /* makedev */
43 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
45 #include "systime.h"
47 #include <fcntl.h>
48 #include <errno.h>
49 #include <sys/stat.h>
50 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
51 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
53 #include "charset.h"
54 #include "character.h"
55 #include "coding.h"
56 #include "frame.h"
57 #include "dispextern.h"
58 #ifdef HAVE_XWIDGETS
59 #include "xwidget.h"
60 #endif
61 #include "fontset.h"
62 #include "termhooks.h"
63 #include "termopts.h"
64 #include "termchar.h"
65 #include "emacs-icon.h"
66 #include "disptab.h"
67 #include "buffer.h"
68 #include "window.h"
69 #include "keyboard.h"
70 #include "intervals.h"
71 #include "process.h"
72 #include "atimer.h"
73 #include "keymap.h"
74 #include "font.h"
75 #include "fontset.h"
76 #include "xsettings.h"
77 #include "xgselect.h"
78 #include "sysselect.h"
80 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
81 #include <X11/Shell.h>
82 #endif
84 #include <unistd.h>
86 #ifdef USE_GTK
87 #include "gtkutil.h"
88 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
89 #include <X11/Xproto.h>
90 #endif
91 #endif
93 #ifdef USE_LUCID
94 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
95 #endif
97 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
98 #if !defined (NO_EDITRES)
99 #define HACK_EDITRES
100 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages (Widget, XtPointer, XEvent *, Boolean *);
101 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
103 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
105 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
106 #if defined USE_MOTIF
107 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
108 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
109 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
111 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
112 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
113 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
114 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
115 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
116 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
117 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
118 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
119 #ifndef XtNpickTop
120 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
121 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
122 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
123 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
125 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
127 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
128 #include "widget.h"
129 #ifndef XtNinitialState
130 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
131 #endif
132 #endif
134 #include "bitmaps/gray.xbm"
136 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
137 #ifdef USE_XIM
138 int use_xim = 1;
139 #else
140 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
141 #endif
145 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
146 start. */
148 static int any_help_event_p;
150 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
151 static Lisp_Object last_window;
153 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
154 use. */
156 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
158 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
159 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
160 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
161 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
163 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
165 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
167 static struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
169 /* This is a frame waiting for an event matching mask, within XTread_socket. */
171 static struct {
172 struct frame *f;
173 int eventtype;
174 } pending_event_wait;
176 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
177 /* The application context for Xt use. */
178 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
179 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
181 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
183 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
184 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
186 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
187 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
188 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
190 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
192 /* Mouse movement.
194 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
195 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
196 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
197 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
199 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
201 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
202 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
203 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
204 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
205 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
206 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
207 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
208 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
209 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
210 is off. */
212 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
214 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
215 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
216 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
218 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
220 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
221 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
222 an ordinary motion.
224 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
225 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
226 event. */
228 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
230 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
231 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
232 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
233 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
234 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
235 it's somewhat accurate. */
237 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
239 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
241 static Time last_user_time;
243 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
244 events. */
246 static int volatile input_signal_count;
248 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
250 static int x_noop_count;
252 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
254 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
255 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
257 #ifdef USE_GTK
258 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
259 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file;
261 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
262 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock;
263 #endif
265 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
266 static char emacs_class[] = EMACS_CLASS;
268 enum xembed_info
270 XEMBED_MAPPED = 1 << 0
273 enum xembed_message
275 XEMBED_EMBEDDED_NOTIFY = 0,
276 XEMBED_WINDOW_ACTIVATE = 1,
277 XEMBED_WINDOW_DEACTIVATE = 2,
278 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS = 3,
279 XEMBED_FOCUS_IN = 4,
280 XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT = 5,
281 XEMBED_FOCUS_NEXT = 6,
282 XEMBED_FOCUS_PREV = 7,
284 XEMBED_MODALITY_ON = 10,
285 XEMBED_MODALITY_OFF = 11,
286 XEMBED_REGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 12,
287 XEMBED_UNREGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 13,
288 XEMBED_ACTIVATE_ACCELERATOR = 14
291 /* Used in x_flush. */
293 static bool x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *, Colormap, XColor *);
294 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *, int, int, int);
295 static void x_raise_frame (struct frame *);
296 static void x_lower_frame (struct frame *);
297 static const XColor *x_color_cells (Display *, int *);
298 static void x_update_window_end (struct window *, int, int);
300 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display *);
301 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *);
302 void x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *);
303 static void x_update_end (struct frame *);
304 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *);
305 static void XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
306 static void XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
307 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame *);
308 static _Noreturn void x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *, int, int);
309 static void frame_highlight (struct frame *);
310 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame *);
311 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *, struct frame *);
312 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info *,
313 struct frame *, struct input_event *);
314 static void x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *,
315 XEvent *, struct input_event *);
316 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *);
317 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *);
318 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *);
319 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
320 enum text_cursor_kinds);
322 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC);
323 static void x_flush (struct frame *f);
324 static void x_update_begin (struct frame *);
325 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window *);
326 static void x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *);
327 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *, Window);
328 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
329 enum scroll_bar_part *,
330 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
331 Time *);
332 static int x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *, XPropertyEvent *);
333 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *);
334 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame *, int, int);
335 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame *, int, int, int);
336 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
337 int *, struct input_event *);
338 #ifdef USE_GTK
339 static int x_dispatch_event (XEvent *, Display *);
340 #endif
341 /* Don't declare this _Noreturn because we want no
342 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
343 static void x_connection_closed (Display *, const char *);
344 static void x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *, int);
345 static void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *, ptrdiff_t);
346 static void x_initialize (void);
349 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
351 static void
352 x_flush (struct frame *f)
354 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
355 connection may be broken. */
356 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
357 return;
359 block_input ();
360 if (f == NULL)
362 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
363 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
364 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
365 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
367 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
368 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
369 unblock_input ();
373 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
374 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
375 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
376 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
377 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
378 performance. */
380 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
383 /***********************************************************************
384 Debugging
385 ***********************************************************************/
387 #if 0
389 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
390 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
392 struct record
394 char *locus;
395 int type;
398 struct record event_record[100];
400 int event_record_index;
402 void
403 record_event (char *locus, int type)
405 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
406 event_record_index = 0;
408 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
409 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
410 event_record_index++;
413 #endif /* 0 */
417 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
419 struct x_display_info *
420 x_display_info_for_display (Display *dpy)
422 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
424 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
425 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
426 return dpyinfo;
428 return 0;
431 static Window
432 x_find_topmost_parent (struct frame *f)
434 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x;
435 Window win = None, wi = x->parent_desc;
436 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
438 while (wi != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
440 Window root;
441 Window *children;
442 unsigned int nchildren;
444 win = wi;
445 XQueryTree (dpy, win, &root, &wi, &children, &nchildren);
446 XFree (children);
449 return win;
452 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
454 void
455 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame *f)
457 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
458 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
459 Window win = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
460 double alpha = 1.0;
461 double alpha_min = 1.0;
462 unsigned long opac;
463 Window parent;
465 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame == f)
466 alpha = f->alpha[0];
467 else
468 alpha = f->alpha[1];
470 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
471 alpha_min = XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit);
472 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
473 alpha_min = (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit)) / 100.0;
475 if (alpha < 0.0)
476 return;
477 else if (alpha > 1.0)
478 alpha = 1.0;
479 else if (0.0 <= alpha && alpha < alpha_min && alpha_min <= 1.0)
480 alpha = alpha_min;
482 opac = alpha * OPAQUE;
484 x_catch_errors (dpy);
486 /* If there is a parent from the window manager, put the property there
487 also, to work around broken window managers that fail to do that.
488 Do this unconditionally as this function is called on reparent when
489 alpha has not changed on the frame. */
491 parent = x_find_topmost_parent (f);
492 if (parent != None)
493 XChangeProperty (dpy, parent, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
494 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
495 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
497 /* return unless necessary */
499 unsigned char *data;
500 Atom actual;
501 int rc, format;
502 unsigned long n, left;
504 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
505 0L, 1L, False, XA_CARDINAL,
506 &actual, &format, &n, &left,
507 &data);
509 if (rc == Success && actual != None)
511 unsigned long value = *(unsigned long *)data;
512 XFree (data);
513 if (value == opac)
515 x_uncatch_errors ();
516 return;
521 XChangeProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
522 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
523 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
524 x_uncatch_errors ();
528 x_display_pixel_height (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
530 return HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
534 x_display_pixel_width (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
536 return WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
540 /***********************************************************************
541 Starting and ending an update
542 ***********************************************************************/
544 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
545 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
546 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
547 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
548 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
550 static void
551 x_update_begin (struct frame *f)
553 /* Nothing to do. */
557 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
558 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
559 position of W. */
561 static void
562 x_update_window_begin (struct window *w)
564 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
565 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
567 updated_window = w;
568 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
570 block_input ();
572 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
574 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
575 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 1;
577 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
578 highlighting. */
579 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
580 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
583 unblock_input ();
587 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
589 static void
590 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window *w, int x, int y0, int y1)
592 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
593 struct face *face;
595 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
596 if (face)
597 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
598 face->foreground);
600 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
601 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
604 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
606 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
607 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
609 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
610 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
611 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
613 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
614 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
615 here. */
617 static void
618 x_update_window_end (struct window *w, int cursor_on_p, int mouse_face_overwritten_p)
620 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
622 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
624 block_input ();
626 if (cursor_on_p)
627 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
628 output_cursor.vpos,
629 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
631 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
632 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
634 unblock_input ();
637 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
638 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
639 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
641 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
642 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
643 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
646 updated_window = NULL;
650 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
651 update_end. */
653 static void
654 x_update_end (struct frame *f)
656 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
657 MOUSE_HL_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
659 #ifndef XFlush
660 block_input ();
661 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
662 unblock_input ();
663 #endif
667 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
668 complete update has been performed. The global variable
669 updated_window is not available here. */
671 static void
672 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *f)
674 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
675 FRAME_MOUSE_UPDATE (f);
679 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
680 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
681 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
682 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
683 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
684 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
686 static void
687 x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *desired_row)
689 struct window *w = updated_window;
690 struct frame *f;
691 int width, height;
693 eassert (w);
695 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
696 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
698 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
699 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
700 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
701 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
702 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
703 overhead is very small. */
704 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
705 && desired_row->full_width_p
706 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
707 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
708 width != 0)
709 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
710 height > 0))
712 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
714 block_input ();
715 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
716 0, y, width, height, False);
717 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
718 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
719 y, width, height, False);
720 unblock_input ();
724 static void
725 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p)
727 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
728 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
729 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
730 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
731 struct face *face = p->face;
733 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
734 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
736 if (!p->overlay_p)
738 int bx = p->bx, by = p->by, nx = p->nx, ny = p->ny;
740 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
741 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
742 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
743 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
744 if (face->stipple)
745 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
746 else
747 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
749 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
750 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
751 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
752 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
753 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
754 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
755 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
756 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
758 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
760 if (sb_width > 0)
762 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
763 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
764 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
766 if (bx < 0)
768 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
769 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == p->x)
770 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
771 else if (p->x + p->wd == bar_area_x)
772 bx = bar_area_x;
773 if (bx >= 0)
775 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
777 nx = bar_area_width - sb_width;
778 by = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
779 row->y));
780 ny = row->visible_height;
783 else
785 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == bx)
787 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
788 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
790 else if (bx + nx == bar_area_x)
791 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
795 #endif
796 if (bx >= 0 && nx > 0)
797 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc, bx, by, nx, ny);
799 if (!face->stipple)
800 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
803 if (p->which)
805 char *bits;
806 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
807 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
808 XGCValues gcv;
810 if (p->wd > 8)
811 bits = (char *) (p->bits + p->dh);
812 else
813 bits = (char *) p->bits + p->dh;
815 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
816 by the server. */
817 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
818 (p->cursor_p
819 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
820 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
821 : face->foreground),
822 face->background, depth);
824 if (p->overlay_p)
826 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
827 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
828 bits, p->wd, p->h,
829 1, 0, 1);
830 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
831 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
832 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
833 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
836 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
837 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
838 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
840 if (p->overlay_p)
842 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
843 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
844 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
848 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
853 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
854 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
855 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
856 rarely happens). */
858 static void
859 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
863 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
864 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
866 static void
867 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
872 /***********************************************************************
873 Glyph display
874 ***********************************************************************/
878 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *);
879 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *);
880 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *,
881 int);
882 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
883 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
884 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *);
885 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
886 static _Noreturn void x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *, int);
887 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *);
888 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *);
889 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
890 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
891 static bool x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
892 unsigned long *, double, int);
893 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *, struct relief *,
894 double, int, unsigned long);
895 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *);
896 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
897 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *);
898 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
899 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *, Pixmap);
900 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *, int,
901 int, int, int);
902 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
903 int, int, int, int, int, int,
904 XRectangle *);
905 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
906 int, int, int, XRectangle *);
907 static void x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame *);
909 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
910 static void x_check_font (struct frame *, struct font *);
911 #endif
914 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
915 face. */
917 static void
918 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
920 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
921 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
922 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
923 && !s->cmp)
924 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
925 else
927 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
928 XGCValues xgcv;
929 unsigned long mask;
931 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
932 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
934 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
935 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
936 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
937 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
938 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
939 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
940 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
942 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
943 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
944 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
946 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
947 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
950 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
951 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
952 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
954 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
955 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
956 mask, &xgcv);
957 else
958 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
959 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
961 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
966 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
968 static void
969 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
971 int face_id;
972 struct face *face;
974 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
975 face_id = MOUSE_HL_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
976 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
977 if (face == NULL)
978 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
980 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
981 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
982 else
983 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
984 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
985 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
987 if (s->font == s->face->font)
988 s->gc = s->face->gc;
989 else
991 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
992 except for FONT. */
993 XGCValues xgcv;
994 unsigned long mask;
996 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
997 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
998 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
999 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
1001 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1002 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1003 mask, &xgcv);
1004 else
1005 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1006 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1008 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1011 eassert (s->gc != 0);
1015 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1016 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1017 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1019 static void
1020 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1022 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1026 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1027 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1028 pattern. */
1030 static void
1031 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1033 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1035 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1037 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1038 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1040 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1042 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1043 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1045 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1047 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1048 s->stippled_p = 0;
1050 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1052 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1053 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1055 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1056 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1058 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1059 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1061 else
1063 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1064 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1067 /* GC must have been set. */
1068 eassert (s->gc != 0);
1072 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1073 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1075 static void
1076 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *s)
1078 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
1079 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
1081 if (n > 0)
1082 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
1083 s->num_clips = n;
1087 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1088 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1089 the area of SRC. */
1091 static void
1092 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string *src, struct glyph_string *dst)
1094 XRectangle r;
1096 r.x = src->x;
1097 r.width = src->width;
1098 r.y = src->y;
1099 r.height = src->height;
1100 dst->clip[0] = r;
1101 dst->num_clips = 1;
1102 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1106 /* RIF:
1107 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1109 static void
1110 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *s)
1112 if (s->cmp == NULL
1113 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
1114 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
1116 struct font_metrics metrics;
1118 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1120 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1121 struct font *font = s->font;
1122 int i;
1124 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1125 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1126 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1128 else
1130 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1132 composition_gstring_width (gstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, &metrics);
1134 s->right_overhang = (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width
1135 ? metrics.rbearing - metrics.width : 0);
1136 s->left_overhang = metrics.lbearing < 0 ? - metrics.lbearing : 0;
1138 else if (s->cmp)
1140 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1141 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1146 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1148 static void
1149 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
1151 XGCValues xgcv;
1152 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1153 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1154 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1155 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1159 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1160 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1161 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1162 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1163 contains the first component of a composition. */
1165 static void
1166 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *s, int force_p)
1168 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1169 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1170 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1172 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1174 if (s->stippled_p)
1176 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1177 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1178 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1179 s->y + box_line_width,
1180 s->background_width,
1181 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1182 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1183 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1185 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1186 || s->font_not_found_p
1187 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1188 || force_p)
1190 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1191 s->background_width,
1192 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1193 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1199 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1201 static void
1202 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1204 int i, x;
1206 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1207 of S to the right of that box line. */
1208 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1209 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1210 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1211 else
1212 x = s->x;
1214 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1215 loaded. */
1216 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1218 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1220 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1221 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1222 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1223 s->height - 1);
1224 x += g->pixel_width;
1227 else
1229 struct font *font = s->font;
1230 int boff = font->baseline_offset;
1231 int y;
1233 if (font->vertical_centering)
1234 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, s->f) - boff;
1236 y = s->ybase - boff;
1237 if (s->for_overlaps
1238 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1239 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 0);
1240 else
1241 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 1);
1242 if (s->face->overstrike)
1243 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, 0);
1247 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1249 static void
1250 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1252 int i, j, x;
1253 struct font *font = s->font;
1255 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1256 of S to the right of that box line. */
1257 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1258 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1259 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1260 else
1261 x = s->x;
1263 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1264 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1265 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1266 this composition. */
1268 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1269 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1270 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1272 if (s->cmp_from == 0)
1273 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1274 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1276 else if (! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
1278 int y = s->ybase;
1280 for (i = 0, j = s->cmp_from; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1281 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with padding
1282 space on the left or right. */
1283 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1285 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1286 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1288 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, 0);
1289 if (s->face->overstrike)
1290 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, 0);
1293 else
1295 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1296 Lisp_Object glyph;
1297 int y = s->ybase;
1298 int width = 0;
1300 for (i = j = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
1302 glyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1303 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph)))
1304 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph);
1305 else
1307 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1309 if (j < i)
1311 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1312 if (s->face->overstrike)
1313 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1314 x += width;
1316 xoff = LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph);
1317 yoff = LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph);
1318 wadjust = LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph);
1319 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, 0);
1320 if (s->face->overstrike)
1321 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff + 1, y + yoff, 0);
1322 x += wadjust;
1323 j = i + 1;
1324 width = 0;
1327 if (j < i)
1329 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1330 if (s->face->overstrike)
1331 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1337 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S for glyphless characters. */
1339 static void
1340 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1342 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
1343 XChar2b char2b[8];
1344 int x, i, j;
1346 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1347 of S to the right of that box line. */
1348 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1349 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1350 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1351 else
1352 x = s->x;
1354 s->char2b = char2b;
1356 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, glyph++)
1358 char buf[7], *str = NULL;
1359 int len = glyph->u.glyphless.len;
1361 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
1363 if (len > 0
1364 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
1365 && (CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display))
1366 >= 1))
1368 Lisp_Object acronym
1369 = (! glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font
1370 ? CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display,
1371 glyph->u.glyphless.ch)
1372 : XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0]);
1373 if (STRINGP (acronym))
1374 str = SSDATA (acronym);
1377 else if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE)
1379 sprintf ((char *) buf, "%0*X",
1380 glyph->u.glyphless.ch < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6,
1381 glyph->u.glyphless.ch);
1382 str = buf;
1385 if (str)
1387 int upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
1388 unsigned code;
1390 /* It is assured that all LEN characters in STR is ASCII. */
1391 for (j = 0; j < len; j++)
1393 code = s->font->driver->encode_char (s->font, str[j]);
1394 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b + j, code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
1396 s->font->driver->draw (s, 0, upper_len,
1397 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff,
1398 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff,
1400 s->font->driver->draw (s, upper_len, len,
1401 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff,
1402 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff,
1405 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method != GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
1406 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1407 x, s->ybase - glyph->ascent,
1408 glyph->pixel_width - 1,
1409 glyph->ascent + glyph->descent - 1);
1410 x += glyph->pixel_width;
1414 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1416 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1417 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *);
1418 static void cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1419 XrmValue *, Cardinal *);
1421 #ifdef USE_LUCID
1423 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1424 cannot be determined. */
1426 static struct frame *
1427 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget)
1429 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1430 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
1431 struct frame *f;
1433 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1435 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1436 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1437 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1438 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1439 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1440 widget = XtParent (widget);
1442 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1443 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1444 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
1446 f = XFRAME (frame);
1447 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
1448 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1449 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo
1450 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1451 return f;
1453 emacs_abort ();
1456 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1457 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1458 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1459 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1460 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1461 Value is true if successful. */
1463 bool
1464 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
1465 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1467 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1468 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1471 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
1474 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1475 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1477 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1479 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1480 sizeof (Screen *)},
1481 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1482 sizeof (Colormap)}
1486 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1487 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1489 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1492 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1494 DPY is the display we are working on.
1496 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1497 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1498 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1499 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1501 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1502 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1504 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1505 we allocated the color or not.
1507 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1509 static Boolean
1510 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *dpy, XrmValue *args, Cardinal *nargs,
1511 XrmValue *from, XrmValue *to,
1512 XtPointer *closure_ret)
1514 Screen *screen;
1515 Colormap cmap;
1516 Pixel pixel;
1517 String color_name;
1518 XColor color;
1520 if (*nargs != 2)
1522 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1523 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1524 "XtToolkitError",
1525 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1526 return False;
1529 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1530 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1531 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1533 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1535 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1536 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1538 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1540 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1541 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1543 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1544 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1546 pixel = color.pixel;
1547 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1549 else
1551 String params[1];
1552 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1554 params[0] = color_name;
1555 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1556 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1557 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1558 params, &nparams);
1559 return False;
1562 if (to->addr != NULL)
1564 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1566 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1567 return False;
1570 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1572 else
1574 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1575 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1578 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1579 return True;
1583 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1584 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1585 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1587 APP is the application context in which we work.
1589 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1590 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1591 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1593 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1595 static void
1596 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app, XrmValuePtr to, XtPointer closure, XrmValuePtr args,
1597 Cardinal *nargs)
1599 if (*nargs != 2)
1601 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1602 "XtToolkitError",
1603 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1604 NULL, NULL);
1606 else if (closure != NULL)
1608 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1609 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1610 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1611 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1612 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1617 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1620 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1621 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1622 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1623 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1625 static const XColor *
1626 x_color_cells (Display *dpy, int *ncells)
1628 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1630 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1632 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1633 int ncolor_cells = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1634 int i;
1636 dpyinfo->color_cells = xnmalloc (ncolor_cells,
1637 sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1638 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = ncolor_cells;
1640 for (i = 0; i < ncolor_cells; ++i)
1641 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1643 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1644 dpyinfo->color_cells, ncolor_cells);
1647 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1648 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1652 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1653 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1655 void
1656 x_query_colors (struct frame *f, XColor *colors, int ncolors)
1658 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1660 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1662 int i;
1663 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1665 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1666 eassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1667 eassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1668 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1671 else
1672 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1676 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1677 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1679 void
1680 x_query_color (struct frame *f, XColor *color)
1682 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1686 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1687 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1688 Value is true if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1689 allocated. */
1691 static bool
1692 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1694 bool rc;
1696 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color) != 0;
1697 if (rc == 0)
1699 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1700 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1701 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1702 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1703 int nearest, i;
1704 int max_color_delta = 255;
1705 int max_delta = 3 * max_color_delta;
1706 int nearest_delta = max_delta + 1;
1707 int ncells;
1708 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1710 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1712 int dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1713 int dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1714 int dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1715 int delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1717 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1719 nearest = i;
1720 nearest_delta = delta;
1724 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1725 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1726 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1727 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color) != 0;
1729 else
1731 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1732 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1733 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1734 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1735 XColor *cached_color;
1737 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1738 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1739 (cached_color->red != color->red
1740 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1741 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1743 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1744 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1745 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1749 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1750 if (rc)
1751 register_color (color->pixel);
1752 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1754 return rc;
1758 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1759 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1760 Value is true if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1761 allocated. */
1763 bool
1764 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame *f, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1766 gamma_correct (f, color);
1767 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1771 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1772 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1773 get color reference counts right. */
1775 unsigned long
1776 x_copy_color (struct frame *f, long unsigned int pixel)
1778 XColor color;
1780 color.pixel = pixel;
1781 block_input ();
1782 x_query_color (f, &color);
1783 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1784 unblock_input ();
1785 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1786 register_color (pixel);
1787 #endif
1788 return color.pixel;
1792 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1793 boosted.
1795 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1796 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1797 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1798 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1799 use an additional additive factor.
1801 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1802 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1803 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1806 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1807 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1808 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1809 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1810 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1811 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1813 static bool
1814 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *f, Display *display, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1816 XColor color, new;
1817 long bright;
1818 bool success_p;
1820 /* Get RGB color values. */
1821 color.pixel = *pixel;
1822 x_query_color (f, &color);
1824 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1825 eassert (factor >= 0);
1826 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1827 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1828 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1830 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1831 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1833 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1834 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1835 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1836 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1837 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1839 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1840 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1841 /* The additive adjustment. */
1842 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1844 if (factor < 1)
1846 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1847 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1848 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1850 else
1852 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1853 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1854 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1858 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1859 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1860 if (success_p)
1862 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1864 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1865 delta to the RGB values. */
1866 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1868 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1869 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1870 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1871 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1873 else
1874 success_p = 1;
1875 *pixel = new.pixel;
1878 return success_p;
1882 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1883 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1884 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1885 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1886 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1887 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1889 static void
1890 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *f, struct relief *relief, double factor, int delta, long unsigned int default_pixel)
1892 XGCValues xgcv;
1893 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1894 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1895 unsigned long pixel;
1896 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1897 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1898 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1899 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1901 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1902 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1904 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1905 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1906 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1907 if (relief->gc
1908 && relief->allocated_p)
1910 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1911 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1914 /* Allocate new color. */
1915 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1916 pixel = background;
1917 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1918 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1920 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1921 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1924 if (relief->gc == 0)
1926 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1927 mask |= GCStipple;
1928 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1930 else
1931 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1935 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1937 static void
1938 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *s)
1940 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1941 unsigned long color;
1943 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1944 color = s->face->box_color;
1945 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1946 && s->img->pixmap
1947 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1948 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1949 else
1951 XGCValues xgcv;
1953 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1954 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1955 color = xgcv.background;
1958 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1959 || color != di->relief_background)
1961 di->relief_background = color;
1962 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1963 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1964 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1965 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1970 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
1971 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
1972 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
1973 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
1974 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
1975 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
1976 when drawing. */
1978 static void
1979 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *f,
1980 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
1981 int raised_p, int top_p, int bot_p, int left_p, int right_p,
1982 XRectangle *clip_rect)
1984 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1985 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
1986 int i;
1987 GC gc;
1989 if (raised_p)
1990 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
1991 else
1992 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
1993 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
1995 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
1996 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
1997 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
1998 corner pixels. */
2000 /* Top. */
2001 if (top_p)
2003 if (width == 1)
2004 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2005 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2006 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2008 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2009 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2010 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2011 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2014 /* Left. */
2015 if (left_p)
2017 if (width == 1)
2018 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2020 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2021 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2023 for (i = (width > 1 ? 1 : 0); i < width; ++i)
2024 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2025 left_x + i, top_y + (i + 1) * top_p,
2026 left_x + i, bottom_y + 1 - (i + 1) * bot_p);
2029 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2030 if (raised_p)
2031 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2032 else
2033 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2034 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2036 if (width > 1)
2038 /* Outermost top line. */
2039 if (top_p)
2040 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2041 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2042 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2044 /* Outermost left line. */
2045 if (left_p)
2046 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2049 /* Bottom. */
2050 if (bot_p)
2052 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2053 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), bottom_y,
2054 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), bottom_y);
2055 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2056 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2057 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2058 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2061 /* Right. */
2062 if (right_p)
2064 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2065 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2066 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2067 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2068 right_x - i, top_y + (i + 1) * top_p,
2069 right_x - i, bottom_y + 1 - (i + 1) * bot_p);
2072 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2076 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2077 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2078 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2079 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2080 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2081 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2083 static void
2084 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *s,
2085 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2086 int left_p, int right_p, XRectangle *clip_rect)
2088 XGCValues xgcv;
2090 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2091 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2092 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2094 /* Top. */
2095 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2096 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2098 /* Left. */
2099 if (left_p)
2100 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2101 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2103 /* Bottom. */
2104 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2105 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2107 /* Right. */
2108 if (right_p)
2109 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2110 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2112 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2113 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2117 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2119 static void
2120 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *s)
2122 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2123 int left_p, right_p;
2124 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2125 XRectangle clip_rect;
2127 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2128 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2129 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2131 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2132 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2133 ? s->first_glyph
2134 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2136 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2137 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2138 left_x = s->x;
2139 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2140 ? last_x - 1
2141 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2142 top_y = s->y;
2143 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2145 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2146 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2147 && (s->prev == NULL
2148 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2149 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2150 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2151 && (s->next == NULL
2152 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2154 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2156 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2157 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2158 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2159 else
2161 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2162 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2163 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2168 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2170 static void
2171 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
2173 int x = s->x;
2174 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2176 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2177 right of that line. */
2178 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2179 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2180 && s->slice.x == 0)
2181 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2183 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2184 by that margin. */
2185 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2186 x += s->img->hmargin;
2187 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2188 y += s->img->vmargin;
2190 if (s->img->pixmap)
2192 if (s->img->mask)
2194 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2195 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2196 trust on the shape extension to be available
2197 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2198 manually. */
2199 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2200 | GCFunction);
2201 XGCValues xgcv;
2202 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2204 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2205 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2206 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2207 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2208 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2210 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2211 image_rect.x = x;
2212 image_rect.y = y;
2213 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2214 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2215 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2216 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2217 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2218 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2220 else
2222 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2224 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2225 image_rect.x = x;
2226 image_rect.y = y;
2227 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2228 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2229 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2230 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2231 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2232 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2234 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2235 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2236 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2237 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2238 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2239 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2240 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2242 int relief = eabs (s->img->relief);
2243 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2244 x - relief, y - relief,
2245 s->slice.width + relief*2 - 1,
2246 s->slice.height + relief*2 - 1);
2250 else
2251 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2252 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2253 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2257 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2259 static void
2260 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *s)
2262 int x1, y1, thick, raised_p, top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p;
2263 XRectangle r;
2264 int x = s->x;
2265 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2267 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2268 right of that line. */
2269 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2270 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2271 && s->slice.x == 0)
2272 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2274 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2275 by that margin. */
2276 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2277 x += s->img->hmargin;
2278 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2279 y += s->img->vmargin;
2281 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2282 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2284 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2285 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2287 else
2289 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2290 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2293 x1 = x + s->slice.width - 1;
2294 y1 = y + s->slice.height - 1;
2295 top_p = bot_p = left_p = right_p = 0;
2297 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2298 x -= thick, left_p = 1;
2299 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2300 y -= thick, top_p = 1;
2301 if (s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width)
2302 x1 += thick, right_p = 1;
2303 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height)
2304 y1 += thick, bot_p = 1;
2306 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2307 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2308 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x, y, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2309 top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, &r);
2313 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2315 static void
2316 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *s, Pixmap pixmap)
2318 int x = 0;
2319 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2321 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2322 right of that line. */
2323 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2324 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2325 && s->slice.x == 0)
2326 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2328 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2329 by that margin. */
2330 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2331 x += s->img->hmargin;
2332 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2333 y += s->img->vmargin;
2335 if (s->img->pixmap)
2337 if (s->img->mask)
2339 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2340 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2341 trust on the shape extension to be available
2342 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2343 manually. */
2344 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2345 | GCFunction);
2346 XGCValues xgcv;
2348 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2349 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2350 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2351 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2352 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2354 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2355 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2356 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2357 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2359 else
2361 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2362 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2363 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2365 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2366 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2367 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2368 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2369 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2370 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2371 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2373 int r = eabs (s->img->relief);
2374 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2375 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2376 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2380 else
2381 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2382 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2383 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2387 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2388 give the rectangle to draw. */
2390 static void
2391 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
2393 if (s->stippled_p)
2395 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2396 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2397 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2398 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2400 else
2401 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2405 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2407 s->y
2408 s->x +-------------------------
2409 | s->face->box
2411 | +-------------------------
2412 | | s->img->margin
2414 | | +-------------------
2415 | | | the image
2419 static void
2420 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2422 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2423 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2424 int height;
2425 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2427 height = s->height;
2428 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2429 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2430 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2431 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2433 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2434 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2435 flickering. */
2436 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2437 if (height > s->slice.height
2438 || s->img->hmargin
2439 || s->img->vmargin
2440 || s->img->mask
2441 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2442 || s->width != s->background_width)
2444 if (s->img->mask)
2446 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2447 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2448 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2449 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2450 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2452 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2453 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2454 s->background_width,
2455 s->height, depth);
2457 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2458 pixmap. */
2459 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2461 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2462 if (s->stippled_p)
2464 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2465 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2466 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2467 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2468 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2469 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2470 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2472 else
2474 XGCValues xgcv;
2475 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2476 &xgcv);
2477 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2478 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2479 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2480 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2483 else
2485 int x = s->x;
2486 int y = s->y;
2488 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2489 && s->slice.x == 0)
2490 x += box_line_hwidth;
2492 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2493 y += box_line_vwidth;
2495 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2498 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2501 /* Draw the foreground. */
2502 if (pixmap != None)
2504 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2505 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2506 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2507 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2508 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2510 else
2511 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2513 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2514 if (s->img->relief
2515 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2516 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2517 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2521 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2523 static void
2524 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2526 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2528 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2529 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2531 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2532 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2533 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2534 int x = s->x;
2536 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2538 int left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2540 if (x < left_x)
2542 background_width -= left_x - x;
2543 x = left_x;
2546 else
2548 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2549 stretch glyph. */
2550 int right_x = window_box_right_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2552 if (x + background_width > right_x)
2553 background_width -= x - right_x;
2554 x += background_width;
2556 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2557 if (s->row->reversed_p)
2558 x -= width;
2560 /* Draw cursor. */
2561 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2563 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2564 if (width < background_width)
2566 int y = s->y;
2567 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2568 XRectangle r;
2569 GC gc;
2571 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2572 x += width;
2573 else
2574 x = s->x;
2575 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2576 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2578 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2579 gc = s->gc;
2581 else
2582 gc = s->face->gc;
2584 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2585 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2587 if (s->face->stipple)
2589 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2590 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2591 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2592 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2594 else
2596 XGCValues xgcv;
2597 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2598 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2599 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2600 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2604 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2606 int background_width = s->background_width;
2607 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2609 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2610 except for header line and mode line. */
2611 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2613 background_width -= left_x - x;
2614 x = left_x;
2616 if (background_width > 0)
2617 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2620 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2624 Draw a wavy line under S. The wave fills wave_height pixels from y0.
2626 x0 wave_length = 2
2628 y0 * * * * *
2629 |* * * * * * * * *
2630 wave_height = 3 | * * * *
2634 static void
2635 x_draw_underwave (struct glyph_string *s)
2637 int wave_height = 2, wave_length = 3;
2638 int dx, dy, x0, y0, width, x1, y1, x2, y2, odd, xmax;
2639 XRectangle wave_clip, string_clip, final_clip;
2641 dx = wave_length;
2642 dy = wave_height - 1;
2643 x0 = s->x;
2644 y0 = s->ybase + 1;
2645 width = s->width;
2646 xmax = x0 + width;
2648 /* Find and set clipping rectangle */
2650 wave_clip = (XRectangle){ x0, y0, width, wave_height };
2651 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &string_clip);
2653 if (!x_intersect_rectangles (&wave_clip, &string_clip, &final_clip))
2654 return;
2656 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &final_clip, 1, Unsorted);
2658 /* Draw the waves */
2660 x1 = x0 - (x0 % dx);
2661 x2 = x1 + dx;
2662 odd = (x1/dx) % 2;
2663 y1 = y2 = y0;
2665 if (odd)
2666 y1 += dy;
2667 else
2668 y2 += dy;
2670 if (INT_MAX - dx < xmax)
2671 emacs_abort ();
2673 while (x1 <= xmax)
2675 XDrawLine (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x1, y1, x2, y2);
2676 x1 = x2, y1 = y2;
2677 x2 += dx, y2 = y0 + odd*dy;
2678 odd = !odd;
2681 /* Restore previous clipping rectangle(s) */
2682 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, s->clip, s->num_clips, Unsorted);
2686 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2688 static void
2689 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2691 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2693 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2694 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2695 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2696 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2698 int width;
2699 struct glyph_string *next;
2701 for (width = 0, next = s->next;
2702 next && width < s->right_overhang;
2703 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2704 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2706 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2707 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2708 if (next->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
2709 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next);
2710 else
2711 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, 1);
2712 next->num_clips = 0;
2716 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2717 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2719 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2720 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2721 if (!s->for_overlaps
2722 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2723 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2724 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2727 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2728 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2729 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2730 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2731 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2733 else if (!s->clip_head /* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2734 && !s->clip_tail
2735 && ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2736 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang)))
2737 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2738 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2739 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2740 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2741 else
2742 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2744 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2746 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2747 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2748 break;
2749 #ifdef HAVE_XWIDGETS
2750 case XWIDGET_GLYPH:
2751 //erase xwidget background
2752 //x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2753 x_draw_xwidget_glyph_string (s);
2754 break;
2755 #endif
2756 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2757 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2758 break;
2760 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2761 if (s->for_overlaps)
2762 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2763 else
2764 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2765 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2766 break;
2768 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2769 if (s->for_overlaps || (s->cmp_from > 0
2770 && ! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic))
2771 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2772 else
2773 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2774 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2775 break;
2777 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH:
2778 if (s->for_overlaps)
2779 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2780 else
2781 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2782 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2783 break;
2785 default:
2786 emacs_abort ();
2789 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2791 /* Draw underline. */
2792 if (s->face->underline_p)
2794 if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_WAVE)
2796 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2797 x_draw_underwave (s);
2798 else
2800 XGCValues xgcv;
2801 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2802 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2803 x_draw_underwave (s);
2804 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2807 else if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_LINE)
2809 unsigned long thickness, position;
2810 int y;
2812 if (s->prev && s->prev->face->underline_p)
2814 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2815 thickness = s->prev->underline_thickness;
2816 position = s->prev->underline_position;
2818 else
2820 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2821 if (s->font && s->font->underline_thickness > 0)
2822 thickness = s->font->underline_thickness;
2823 else
2824 thickness = 1;
2825 if (x_underline_at_descent_line)
2826 position = (s->height - thickness) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2827 else
2829 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2830 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2831 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2832 specs, and its default is
2834 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2835 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2837 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2838 && s->font && s->font->underline_position >= 0)
2839 position = s->font->underline_position;
2840 else if (s->font)
2841 position = (s->font->descent + 1) / 2;
2842 else
2843 position = underline_minimum_offset;
2845 position = max (position, underline_minimum_offset);
2847 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2848 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2849 if (s->y + s->height <= s->ybase + position)
2850 position = (s->height - 1) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2851 if (s->y + s->height < s->ybase + position + thickness)
2852 thickness = (s->y + s->height) - (s->ybase + position);
2853 s->underline_thickness = thickness;
2854 s->underline_position = position;
2855 y = s->ybase + position;
2856 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2857 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2858 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2859 else
2861 XGCValues xgcv;
2862 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2863 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2864 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2865 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2866 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2870 /* Draw overline. */
2871 if (s->face->overline_p)
2873 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2875 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2876 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2877 s->width, h);
2878 else
2880 XGCValues xgcv;
2881 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2882 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2883 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2884 s->width, h);
2885 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2889 /* Draw strike-through. */
2890 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2892 unsigned long h = 1;
2893 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2895 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2896 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2897 s->width, h);
2898 else
2900 XGCValues xgcv;
2901 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2902 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2903 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2904 s->width, h);
2905 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2909 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2910 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2911 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2913 if (s->prev)
2915 struct glyph_string *prev;
2917 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
2918 if (prev->hl != s->hl
2919 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
2921 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2922 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2923 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
2925 prev->hl = s->hl;
2926 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
2927 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
2928 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2929 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2930 else
2931 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2932 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
2933 prev->hl = save;
2934 prev->num_clips = 0;
2938 if (s->next)
2940 struct glyph_string *next;
2942 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
2943 if (next->hl != s->hl
2944 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
2946 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2947 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2948 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
2950 next->hl = s->hl;
2951 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2952 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
2953 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2954 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2955 else
2956 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2957 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
2958 next->hl = save;
2959 next->num_clips = 0;
2960 next->clip_head = s->next;
2965 /* Reset clipping. */
2966 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2967 s->num_clips = 0;
2970 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2972 static void
2973 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height, int shift_by)
2975 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2976 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2977 x, y, width, height,
2978 x + shift_by, y);
2981 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2982 for X frames. */
2984 static void
2985 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *f, register int n)
2987 emacs_abort ();
2991 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2992 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2994 void
2995 x_clear_area (Display *dpy, Window window, int x, int y, int width, int height, int exposures)
2997 eassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2998 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
3002 /* Clear an entire frame. */
3004 static void
3005 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
3007 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
3008 longer visible. */
3009 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
3010 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
3011 output_cursor.x = -1;
3013 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
3014 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
3015 block_input ();
3017 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
3019 /* We have to clear the scroll bars. If we have changed colors or
3020 something like that, then they should be notified. */
3021 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
3023 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
3024 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
3025 redisplay, do it here. */
3026 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
3027 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3028 #endif
3030 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3032 unblock_input ();
3037 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
3039 static void
3040 XTflash (struct frame *f)
3042 block_input ();
3045 #ifdef USE_GTK
3046 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
3047 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
3048 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3049 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3050 cairo_t *cr = gdk_cairo_create (window);
3051 cairo_set_source_rgb (cr, 1, 1, 1);
3052 cairo_set_operator (cr, CAIRO_OPERATOR_DIFFERENCE);
3053 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3054 do { \
3055 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, w, h); \
3056 cairo_fill (cr); \
3058 while (0)
3059 #else /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3060 GdkGCValues vals;
3061 GdkGC *gc;
3062 vals.foreground.pixel = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3063 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3064 vals.function = GDK_XOR;
3065 gc = gdk_gc_new_with_values (window,
3066 &vals, GDK_GC_FUNCTION | GDK_GC_FOREGROUND);
3067 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3068 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
3069 #endif /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3070 #else /* ! USE_GTK */
3071 GC gc;
3073 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3074 pixels into background pixels. */
3076 XGCValues values;
3078 values.function = GXxor;
3079 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3080 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3082 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3083 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
3085 #endif
3087 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3088 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
3089 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3090 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
3091 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3092 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3093 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3095 int width;
3097 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
3098 edge it is next to. */
3099 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
3101 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
3102 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3103 break;
3105 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
3106 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3107 break;
3109 default:
3110 break;
3113 width = flash_right - flash_left;
3115 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3116 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3118 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3119 flash_left,
3120 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3121 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3122 width, flash_height);
3123 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3124 flash_left,
3125 (height - flash_height
3126 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3127 width, flash_height);
3130 else
3131 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3132 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3133 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3134 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3136 x_flush (f);
3139 EMACS_TIME delay = make_emacs_time (0, 150 * 1000 * 1000);
3140 EMACS_TIME wakeup = add_emacs_time (current_emacs_time (), delay);
3142 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3143 available. */
3144 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3146 EMACS_TIME current = current_emacs_time ();
3147 EMACS_TIME timeout;
3149 /* Break if result would not be positive. */
3150 if (EMACS_TIME_LE (wakeup, current))
3151 break;
3153 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3154 timeout = make_emacs_time (0, 10 * 1000 * 1000);
3156 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3157 pselect (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout, NULL);
3161 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3162 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3164 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3165 flash_left,
3166 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3167 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3168 width, flash_height);
3169 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3170 flash_left,
3171 (height - flash_height
3172 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3173 width, flash_height);
3175 else
3176 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3177 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3178 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3179 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3181 #ifdef USE_GTK
3182 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3183 cairo_destroy (cr);
3184 #else
3185 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc));
3186 #endif
3187 #undef XFillRectangle
3188 #else
3189 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3190 #endif
3191 x_flush (f);
3195 unblock_input ();
3199 static void
3200 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (FRAME_PTR f, int invisible)
3202 block_input ();
3203 if (invisible)
3205 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor != 0)
3206 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3207 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor);
3209 else
3210 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3211 f->output_data.x->current_cursor);
3212 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
3213 unblock_input ();
3217 /* Make audible bell. */
3219 static void
3220 XTring_bell (struct frame *f)
3222 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3224 if (visible_bell)
3225 XTflash (f);
3226 else
3228 block_input ();
3229 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3230 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3231 unblock_input ();
3237 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3238 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3239 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3240 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3242 static void
3243 XTset_terminal_window (struct frame *f, int n)
3245 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3250 /***********************************************************************
3251 Line Dance
3252 ***********************************************************************/
3254 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3255 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3257 static void
3258 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *f, int vpos, int n)
3260 emacs_abort ();
3264 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3266 static void
3267 x_scroll_run (struct window *w, struct run *run)
3269 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3270 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3272 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3273 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3274 fringe of W. */
3275 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3277 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3278 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
3279 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
3280 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
3281 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
3282 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
3283 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
3284 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
3286 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
3288 if (sb_width > 0)
3290 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
3291 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
3292 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
3294 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == x)
3296 x = bar_area_x + sb_width;
3297 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3299 else if (x + width == bar_area_x)
3300 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3303 #endif
3305 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3306 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3307 bottom_y = y + height;
3309 if (to_y < from_y)
3311 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3312 line at the bottom. */
3313 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3314 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3315 else
3316 height = run->height;
3318 else
3320 /* Scrolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3321 at the bottom. */
3322 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3323 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3324 else
3325 height = run->height;
3328 block_input ();
3330 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3331 updated_window = w;
3332 x_clear_cursor (w);
3334 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3335 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3336 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3337 x, from_y,
3338 width, height,
3339 x, to_y);
3341 unblock_input ();
3346 /***********************************************************************
3347 Exposure Events
3348 ***********************************************************************/
3351 static void
3352 frame_highlight (struct frame *f)
3354 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3355 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3356 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3357 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3358 block_input ();
3359 /* I recently started to get errors in this XSetWindowBorder, depending on
3360 the window-manager in use, tho something more is at play since I've been
3361 using that same window-manager binary for ever. Let's not crash just
3362 because of this (bug#9310). */
3363 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3364 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3365 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3366 x_uncatch_errors ();
3367 unblock_input ();
3368 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3369 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3372 static void
3373 frame_unhighlight (struct frame *f)
3375 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3376 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3377 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3378 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3379 block_input ();
3380 /* Same as above for XSetWindowBorder (bug#9310). */
3381 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3382 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3383 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3384 x_uncatch_errors ();
3385 unblock_input ();
3386 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3387 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3390 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3391 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3392 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3393 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3394 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3396 static void
3397 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame)
3399 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3401 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3403 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3404 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3405 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3407 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3408 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3410 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3411 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3412 else
3413 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3416 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3419 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3420 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3421 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3423 static void
3424 x_focus_changed (int type, int state, struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame, struct input_event *bufp)
3426 if (type == FocusIn)
3428 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3430 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3431 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3433 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3434 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3435 /* When run as a daemon, Vterminal_frame is always NIL. */
3436 if ((NILP (Vterminal_frame) || EQ (Fdaemonp(), Qt))
3437 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3438 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3440 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3441 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3445 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3447 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3448 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3449 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3450 #endif
3452 else if (type == FocusOut)
3454 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3456 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3458 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3459 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3462 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3463 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3464 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3465 #endif
3466 if (frame->pointer_invisible)
3467 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame, 0);
3471 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3472 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3474 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3476 static void
3477 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event, struct input_event *bufp)
3479 struct frame *frame;
3481 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3482 if (! frame)
3483 return;
3485 switch (event->type)
3487 case EnterNotify:
3488 case LeaveNotify:
3490 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3491 int focus_state
3492 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3494 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3495 && event->xcrossing.focus
3496 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3497 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3498 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3499 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3501 break;
3503 case FocusIn:
3504 case FocusOut:
3505 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3506 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3507 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3508 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3509 break;
3511 case ClientMessage:
3512 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3514 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3515 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3516 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3518 break;
3523 #if defined HAVE_MENUS && !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
3524 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3526 void
3527 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3529 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3531 #endif
3533 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3534 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3535 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3537 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3538 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3539 the appropriate X display info. */
3541 static void
3542 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *frame)
3544 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3547 static void
3548 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3550 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3552 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3554 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3555 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3556 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3557 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3558 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3560 fset_focus_frame (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame, Qnil);
3561 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3564 else
3565 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3567 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3569 if (old_highlight)
3570 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3571 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3572 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3578 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3580 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3581 static void
3582 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3584 int min_code, max_code;
3585 KeySym *syms;
3586 int syms_per_code;
3587 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3589 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3590 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3591 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3592 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3593 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3595 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3597 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3598 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3599 &syms_per_code);
3600 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3602 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3603 Alt keysyms are on. */
3605 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3606 int found_alt_or_meta;
3608 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3610 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3611 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3613 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3615 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3616 if (code == 0)
3617 continue;
3619 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3621 int code_col;
3623 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3625 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3627 switch (sym)
3629 case XK_Meta_L:
3630 case XK_Meta_R:
3631 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3632 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3633 break;
3635 case XK_Alt_L:
3636 case XK_Alt_R:
3637 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3638 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3639 break;
3641 case XK_Hyper_L:
3642 case XK_Hyper_R:
3643 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3644 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3645 code_col = syms_per_code;
3646 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3647 break;
3649 case XK_Super_L:
3650 case XK_Super_R:
3651 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3652 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3653 code_col = syms_per_code;
3654 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3655 break;
3657 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3658 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3659 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3660 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3661 code_col = syms_per_code;
3662 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3663 break;
3671 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3672 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3674 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3675 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3678 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3679 make them just meta, not alt. */
3680 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3682 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3685 XFree (syms);
3686 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3689 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3690 Emacs uses. */
3693 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, int state)
3695 int mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3696 int mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3697 int mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3698 int mod_super = super_modifier;
3699 Lisp_Object tem;
3701 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3702 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3703 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3704 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3705 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3706 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3707 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3708 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3710 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3711 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3712 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3713 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3714 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3715 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3718 static int
3719 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, EMACS_INT state)
3721 EMACS_INT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3722 EMACS_INT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3723 EMACS_INT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3724 EMACS_INT mod_super = super_modifier;
3726 Lisp_Object tem;
3728 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3729 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem);
3730 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3731 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem);
3732 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3733 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem);
3734 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3735 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem);
3738 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3739 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3740 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3741 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3742 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3743 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3746 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3748 char *
3749 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym)
3751 char *value;
3753 block_input ();
3754 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3755 unblock_input ();
3757 return value;
3762 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3764 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3766 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3767 the mouse. */
3769 static Lisp_Object
3770 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event *result, XButtonEvent *event, struct frame *f)
3772 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3773 otherwise. */
3774 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3775 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3776 result->timestamp = event->time;
3777 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3778 event->state)
3779 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3780 ? up_modifier
3781 : down_modifier));
3783 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3784 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3785 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3786 result->arg = Qnil;
3787 return Qnil;
3791 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3792 The input handler calls this.
3794 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3795 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3796 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3797 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3799 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3800 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3802 static int
3803 note_mouse_movement (FRAME_PTR frame, XMotionEvent *event)
3805 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3806 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3807 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3809 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3810 return 0;
3812 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3814 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3815 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3816 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3817 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3818 return 1;
3822 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3823 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3824 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3825 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3826 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3827 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3829 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3830 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3831 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3832 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3833 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3834 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3835 return 1;
3838 return 0;
3842 /************************************************************************
3843 Mouse Face
3844 ************************************************************************/
3846 static void
3847 redo_mouse_highlight (void)
3849 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3850 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3851 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3852 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3853 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3858 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3859 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3861 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3862 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3863 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3864 position on the scroll bar.
3866 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3867 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3868 the mouse is over.
3870 Set *TIMESTAMP to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3871 was at this position.
3873 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3875 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3876 movement. */
3878 static void
3879 XTmouse_position (FRAME_PTR *fp, int insist, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
3880 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y,
3881 Time *timestamp)
3883 FRAME_PTR f1;
3885 block_input ();
3887 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3888 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, timestamp);
3889 else
3891 Window root;
3892 int root_x, root_y;
3894 Window dummy_window;
3895 int dummy;
3897 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3899 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3900 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3901 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
3902 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3903 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3905 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3907 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3908 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3909 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3911 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3912 &root,
3914 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3915 a different screen. */
3916 &dummy_window,
3918 /* The position on that root window. */
3919 &root_x, &root_y,
3921 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3922 &dummy, &dummy,
3924 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3925 we don't care. */
3926 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3928 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3929 containing the pointer. */
3931 Window win, child;
3932 int win_x, win_y;
3933 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3935 win = root;
3937 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3938 structure is changing at the same time this function
3939 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3941 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3943 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3944 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3946 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3947 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3948 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3950 /* From-window, to-window. */
3951 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3953 /* From-position, to-position. */
3954 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3956 /* Child of win. */
3957 &child);
3958 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3960 else
3962 while (1)
3964 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3966 /* From-window, to-window. */
3967 root, win,
3969 /* From-position, to-position. */
3970 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3972 /* Child of win. */
3973 &child);
3975 if (child == None || child == win)
3976 break;
3977 #ifdef USE_GTK
3978 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3979 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
3980 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
3981 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
3982 if (x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win))
3983 break;
3984 #endif
3985 win = child;
3986 parent_x = win_x;
3987 parent_y = win_y;
3990 /* Now we know that:
3991 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3992 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3993 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3994 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3995 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3996 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3997 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3998 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3999 never use them in that case.) */
4001 #ifdef USE_GTK
4002 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
4003 want the edit window. */
4004 f1 = x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4005 #else
4006 /* Is win one of our frames? */
4007 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4008 #endif
4010 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4011 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
4012 on the frame. */
4013 if (f1 != NULL
4014 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
4015 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
4016 f1 = NULL;
4017 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
4020 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
4021 f1 = 0;
4023 x_uncatch_errors ();
4025 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
4026 if (! f1)
4028 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4030 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
4032 if (bar)
4034 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4035 win_x = parent_x;
4036 win_y = parent_y;
4040 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
4041 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
4043 if (f1)
4045 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
4046 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
4047 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
4048 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
4049 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
4050 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
4051 the frame are divided into. */
4053 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
4054 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
4056 *bar_window = Qnil;
4057 *part = 0;
4058 *fp = f1;
4059 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
4060 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
4061 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
4066 unblock_input ();
4071 /***********************************************************************
4072 Scroll bars
4073 ***********************************************************************/
4075 /* Scroll bar support. */
4077 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4078 manages it.
4079 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4080 bits. */
4082 static struct scroll_bar *
4083 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *display, Window window_id)
4085 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
4087 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4088 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
4089 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4091 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
4093 Lisp_Object bar, condemned;
4095 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4096 continue;
4098 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4099 right window ID. */
4100 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4101 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4102 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4103 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4104 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
4105 condemned = Qnil,
4106 ! NILP (bar));
4107 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
4108 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id &&
4109 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
4110 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
4113 return NULL;
4117 #if defined USE_LUCID
4119 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4120 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4122 static Widget
4123 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window)
4125 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
4127 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
4128 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4130 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
4132 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
4133 return menu_bar;
4135 return NULL;
4138 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4141 /************************************************************************
4142 Toolkit scroll bars
4143 ************************************************************************/
4145 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4147 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *, struct input_event *);
4148 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object, int, int, int);
4149 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *,
4150 struct scroll_bar *);
4151 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *,
4152 int, int, int);
4155 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4156 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4158 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4160 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4162 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4164 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4165 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4167 #ifndef USE_GTK
4168 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4170 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4172 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4174 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4175 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4176 to avoid jerkiness. */
4178 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4180 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4181 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4182 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4183 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4185 static void
4186 xt_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
4187 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
4189 int scroll_bar_p;
4190 const char *end_action;
4192 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4193 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4194 end_action = "Release";
4195 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4196 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4197 end_action = "EndScroll";
4198 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4200 if (scroll_bar_p
4201 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4202 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4204 struct window *w;
4206 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4207 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4208 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4210 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4212 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4213 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4214 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4216 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4217 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4219 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4220 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4223 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4225 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4226 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4228 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4229 static ptrdiff_t scroll_bar_windows_size;
4232 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4233 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4234 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4235 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4237 static void
4238 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window, int part, int portion, int whole)
4240 XEvent event;
4241 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4242 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4243 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4244 ptrdiff_t i;
4246 block_input ();
4248 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4249 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4250 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4251 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4252 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4253 ev->format = 32;
4255 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4256 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4257 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4258 into that array in the event. */
4259 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4260 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4261 break;
4263 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4265 ptrdiff_t old_nbytes =
4266 scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4267 ptrdiff_t nbytes;
4268 enum { XClientMessageEvent_MAX = 0x7fffffff };
4269 scroll_bar_windows =
4270 xpalloc (scroll_bar_windows, &scroll_bar_windows_size, 1,
4271 XClientMessageEvent_MAX, sizeof *scroll_bar_windows);
4272 nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4273 memset (&scroll_bar_windows[i], 0, nbytes - old_nbytes);
4276 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4277 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4278 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4279 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4280 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4281 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4283 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4284 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4285 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4286 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4287 #endif
4289 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4290 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4291 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4292 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4293 unblock_input ();
4297 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4298 in *IEVENT. */
4300 static void
4301 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *event, struct input_event *ievent)
4303 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4304 Lisp_Object window;
4305 struct window *w;
4307 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4308 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4310 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4312 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4313 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4314 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4315 #ifdef USE_GTK
4316 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4317 #else
4318 ievent->timestamp =
4319 XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (w->frame)));
4320 #endif
4321 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4322 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4323 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4324 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4325 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4329 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4331 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4333 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4336 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4337 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4338 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4340 static void
4341 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4343 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4344 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4345 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4347 switch (cs->reason)
4349 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4350 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4351 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4352 break;
4354 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4355 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4356 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4357 break;
4359 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4360 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4361 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4362 break;
4364 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4365 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4366 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4367 break;
4369 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4370 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4371 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4372 break;
4374 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4375 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4376 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4377 break;
4379 case XmCR_DRAG:
4381 int slider_size;
4383 /* Get the slider size. */
4384 block_input ();
4385 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4386 unblock_input ();
4388 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4389 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4390 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4391 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4393 break;
4395 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4396 break;
4399 if (part >= 0)
4401 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4402 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4403 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4407 #elif defined USE_GTK
4409 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4410 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4412 static gboolean
4413 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange *range,
4414 GtkScrollType scroll,
4415 gdouble value,
4416 gpointer user_data)
4418 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4419 gdouble position;
4420 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4421 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range));
4422 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range), XG_FRAME_DATA);
4424 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return FALSE;
4425 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4428 switch (scroll)
4430 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP:
4431 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4432 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed != 0
4433 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed < (1 << 4))
4435 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4436 whole = gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
4437 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj);
4438 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4439 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4441 break;
4442 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD:
4443 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4444 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4445 break;
4446 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD:
4447 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4448 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4449 break;
4450 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD:
4451 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4452 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4453 break;
4454 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD:
4455 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4456 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4457 break;
4460 if (part >= 0)
4462 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4463 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4464 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4467 return FALSE;
4470 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to Qnil when dragging is done. */
4472 static gboolean
4473 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget *widget,
4474 GdkEventButton *event,
4475 gpointer user_data)
4477 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4478 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4479 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4481 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4482 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4483 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4486 return FALSE;
4490 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4492 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4493 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4494 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4495 the thumb is. */
4497 static void
4498 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4500 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4501 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4502 float shown;
4503 int whole, portion, height;
4504 int part;
4506 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4507 block_input ();
4508 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4509 unblock_input ();
4511 whole = 10000000;
4512 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4514 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0f / height))
4515 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4516 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4517 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4518 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4519 bottom). */
4520 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4521 else
4522 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4524 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4525 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4526 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4527 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4531 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4532 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4533 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4534 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4535 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4536 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4537 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4539 static void
4540 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4542 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4543 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4544 int position = (long) call_data;
4545 Dimension height;
4546 int part;
4548 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4549 block_input ();
4550 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4551 unblock_input ();
4553 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4554 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4556 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4557 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4558 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4559 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4560 else
4561 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4563 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4564 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4565 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4566 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4569 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4571 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4573 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4574 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4576 #ifdef USE_GTK
4577 static void
4578 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4580 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4582 block_input ();
4583 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4584 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
4585 scroll_bar_name);
4586 unblock_input ();
4589 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4591 static void
4592 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4594 Window xwindow;
4595 Widget widget;
4596 Arg av[20];
4597 int ac = 0;
4598 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4599 unsigned long pixel;
4601 block_input ();
4603 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4604 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4605 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4606 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4607 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4608 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4609 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4610 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4611 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4613 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4614 if (pixel != -1)
4616 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4617 ++ac;
4620 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4621 if (pixel != -1)
4623 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4624 ++ac;
4627 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4628 (char *) scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4630 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4631 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4632 (XtPointer) bar);
4633 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4634 (XtPointer) bar);
4635 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4636 (XtPointer) bar);
4637 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4638 (XtPointer) bar);
4639 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4640 (XtPointer) bar);
4641 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4642 (XtPointer) bar);
4643 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4644 (XtPointer) bar);
4646 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4647 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4649 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4650 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4651 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4652 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4654 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4656 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4657 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4658 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4659 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4660 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4661 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4662 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4663 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4665 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4666 if (pixel != -1)
4668 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4669 ++ac;
4672 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4673 if (pixel != -1)
4675 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4676 ++ac;
4679 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4681 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4682 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4684 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4685 if (pixel != -1)
4687 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4688 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4689 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4690 pixel = -1;
4691 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4694 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4696 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4697 if (pixel != -1)
4699 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4700 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4701 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4702 pixel = -1;
4703 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4707 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4708 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4709 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4710 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4711 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4712 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4713 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4714 colors itself. */
4716 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
4717 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
4718 ++ac;
4720 else
4721 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4722 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4723 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4725 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4726 the shadows. */
4727 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4728 ++ac;
4730 /* Specify the colors. */
4731 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4732 if (pixel != -1)
4734 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4735 ++ac;
4737 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4738 if (pixel != -1)
4740 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4741 ++ac;
4744 #endif
4746 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4747 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4750 char const *initial = "";
4751 char const *val = initial;
4752 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4753 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4754 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4755 #endif
4756 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4757 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4758 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4759 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4760 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4761 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4765 /* Define callbacks. */
4766 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4767 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4768 (XtPointer) bar);
4770 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4771 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4773 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4775 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4776 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4777 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4778 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4780 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4781 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4782 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4783 bar->x_window = xwindow;
4785 unblock_input ();
4787 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4790 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4791 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4793 #ifdef USE_GTK
4794 static void
4795 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
4797 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4800 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4801 static void
4802 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
4803 int whole)
4805 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4806 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4807 float top, shown;
4809 block_input ();
4811 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4813 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4814 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4815 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4816 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4817 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4818 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4819 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4820 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4821 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4822 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4823 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4824 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4825 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4826 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4827 whole += portion;
4829 if (whole <= 0)
4830 top = 0, shown = 1;
4831 else
4833 top = (float) position / whole;
4834 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4837 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4839 int size, value;
4841 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4842 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4843 value. */
4844 size = clip_to_bounds (1, shown * XM_SB_MAX, XM_SB_MAX);
4846 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4847 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4848 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4850 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4852 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4854 if (whole == 0)
4855 top = 0, shown = 1;
4856 else
4858 top = (float) position / whole;
4859 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4863 float old_top, old_shown;
4864 Dimension height;
4865 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4866 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4867 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4868 XtNheight, &height,
4869 NULL);
4871 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4872 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4873 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4874 else
4875 top = old_top;
4876 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4877 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0f / height), shown));
4879 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4880 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4881 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4882 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4884 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4885 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4886 else
4888 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4889 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4890 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4892 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4896 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4898 unblock_input ();
4900 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4902 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4906 /************************************************************************
4907 Scroll bars, general
4908 ************************************************************************/
4910 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4911 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4912 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4913 scroll bar. */
4915 static struct scroll_bar *
4916 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window *w, int top, int left, int width, int height)
4918 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4919 struct scroll_bar *bar
4920 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
4921 Lisp_Object barobj;
4923 block_input ();
4925 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4926 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4927 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4929 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4930 unsigned long mask;
4931 Window window;
4933 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4934 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4935 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
4937 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4938 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4939 | ExposureMask);
4940 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4942 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4944 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4945 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4946 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4947 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4948 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4949 left, top, width,
4950 window_box_height (w), False);
4952 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4953 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4954 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4955 top,
4956 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4957 height,
4958 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4960 CopyFromParent,
4961 CopyFromParent,
4962 CopyFromParent,
4963 /* Attributes. */
4964 mask, &a);
4965 bar->x_window = window;
4967 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4969 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4970 bar->top = top;
4971 bar->left = left;
4972 bar->width = width;
4973 bar->height = height;
4974 bar->start = 0;
4975 bar->end = 0;
4976 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4977 bar->fringe_extended_p = 0;
4979 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4980 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4981 bar->prev = Qnil;
4982 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
4983 fset_scroll_bars (f, barobj);
4984 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4985 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4987 /* Map the window/widget. */
4988 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4990 #ifdef USE_GTK
4991 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4992 bar->x_window,
4993 top,
4994 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4995 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4996 max (height, 1));
4997 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4998 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4999 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
5000 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5001 top,
5002 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5003 max (height, 1), 0);
5004 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
5005 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5007 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5008 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5009 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5011 unblock_input ();
5012 return bar;
5016 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5018 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
5020 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
5021 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
5022 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
5023 events.)
5025 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
5026 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
5027 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
5028 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
5029 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
5031 static void
5032 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar *bar, int start, int end, int rebuild)
5034 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
5035 Window w = bar->x_window;
5036 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5037 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5039 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
5040 if (! rebuild
5041 && start == bar->start
5042 && end == bar->end)
5043 return;
5045 block_input ();
5048 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
5049 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
5050 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5052 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
5053 the distance between start and end. */
5055 int length = end - start;
5057 if (start < 0)
5058 start = 0;
5059 else if (start > top_range)
5060 start = top_range;
5061 end = start + length;
5063 if (end < start)
5064 end = start;
5065 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
5066 end = top_range;
5069 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5070 bar->start = start;
5071 bar->end = end;
5073 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5074 if (end > top_range)
5075 end = top_range;
5077 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5078 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5079 that many pixels tall. */
5080 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
5082 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5083 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5084 if (0 < start)
5085 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5086 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5087 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5088 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
5089 inside_width, start,
5090 False);
5092 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5093 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5094 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5095 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5097 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5098 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5099 /* x, y, width, height */
5100 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5101 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
5102 inside_width, end - start);
5104 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5105 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5106 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5107 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5109 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5110 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5111 if (end < inside_height)
5112 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5113 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5114 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5115 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
5116 inside_width, inside_height - end,
5117 False);
5121 unblock_input ();
5124 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5126 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5127 nil. */
5129 static void
5130 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar *bar)
5132 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5133 block_input ();
5135 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5136 #ifdef USE_GTK
5137 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
5138 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5139 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5140 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5141 #else
5142 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5143 #endif
5145 /* Dissociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5146 wset_vertical_scroll_bar (XWINDOW (bar->window), Qnil);
5148 unblock_input ();
5152 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5153 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5154 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5155 create one. */
5157 static void
5158 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
5160 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5161 Lisp_Object barobj;
5162 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5163 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5164 int window_y, window_height;
5165 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5166 int fringe_extended_p;
5167 #endif
5169 /* Get window dimensions. */
5170 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5171 top = window_y;
5172 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5173 height = window_height;
5175 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5176 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5178 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5179 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5180 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5181 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5182 else
5183 sb_width = width;
5185 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5186 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5187 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5188 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w) ? width - sb_width : 0);
5189 else
5190 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w) ? 0 : width - sb_width);
5191 #else
5192 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5193 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5194 else
5195 sb_left = left;
5196 #endif
5198 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5199 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5200 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5201 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5202 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5203 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5204 else
5205 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5206 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5207 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5208 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5209 #endif
5211 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5212 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5214 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5216 block_input ();
5217 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5218 if (fringe_extended_p)
5219 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5220 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5221 else
5222 #endif
5223 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5224 left, top, width, height, False);
5225 unblock_input ();
5228 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5230 else
5232 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5233 unsigned int mask = 0;
5235 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5237 block_input ();
5239 if (sb_left != bar->left)
5240 mask |= CWX;
5241 if (top != bar->top)
5242 mask |= CWY;
5243 if (sb_width != bar->width)
5244 mask |= CWWidth;
5245 if (height != bar->height)
5246 mask |= CWHeight;
5248 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5250 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5251 if (mask || bar->fringe_extended_p != fringe_extended_p)
5253 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5254 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5255 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5257 if (fringe_extended_p)
5258 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5259 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5260 else
5261 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5262 left, top, width, height, False);
5264 #ifdef USE_GTK
5265 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5266 bar->x_window,
5267 top,
5268 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5269 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5270 max (height, 1));
5271 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5272 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5273 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5274 top,
5275 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5276 max (height, 1), 0);
5277 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5279 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5281 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5282 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5283 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5285 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5286 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5287 height, False);
5288 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5289 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5290 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5291 height, False);
5294 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5295 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5296 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5297 example. */
5299 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5300 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5301 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5303 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5304 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5305 left + area_width - rest, top,
5306 rest, height, False);
5307 else
5308 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5309 left, top, rest, height, False);
5313 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5314 if (mask)
5316 XWindowChanges wc;
5318 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5319 wc.y = top;
5320 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5321 wc.height = height;
5322 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5323 mask, &wc);
5326 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5328 /* Remember new settings. */
5329 bar->left = sb_left;
5330 bar->top = top;
5331 bar->width = sb_width;
5332 bar->height = height;
5334 unblock_input ();
5337 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5338 bar->fringe_extended_p = fringe_extended_p;
5340 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5341 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5342 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5343 dragged. */
5344 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5346 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5348 if (whole == 0)
5349 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5350 else
5352 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5353 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5354 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5357 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5359 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
5360 wset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, barobj);
5364 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5365 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5366 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5367 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5368 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5369 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5370 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5372 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5373 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5374 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5376 static void
5377 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR frame)
5379 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5380 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5382 Lisp_Object bar;
5383 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5384 fset_scroll_bars (frame, XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next);
5385 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5386 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5387 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5388 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5389 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (frame, bar);
5394 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5395 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5397 static void
5398 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window *window)
5400 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5401 struct frame *f;
5402 Lisp_Object barobj;
5404 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5405 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5406 emacs_abort ();
5408 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5410 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5411 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5412 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5414 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5415 the lists. */
5416 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5417 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5418 return;
5419 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5420 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5421 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f, bar->next);
5422 else
5423 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5424 one or the other! */
5425 emacs_abort ();
5427 else
5428 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5430 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5431 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5433 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5434 bar->prev = Qnil;
5435 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
5436 fset_scroll_bars (f, barobj);
5437 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5438 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5441 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5442 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5444 static void
5445 XTjudge_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR f)
5447 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5449 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5451 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5452 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5453 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f, Qnil);
5455 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5457 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5459 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5461 next = b->next;
5462 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5465 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5466 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5470 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5471 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5472 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5474 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5475 mark bits. */
5477 static void
5478 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5480 Window w = bar->x_window;
5481 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5482 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5483 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5485 block_input ();
5487 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, 1);
5489 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5490 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5491 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5492 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5494 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5495 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5497 /* x, y, width, height */
5498 0, 0,
5499 bar->width - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5500 bar->height - 1);
5502 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5503 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5504 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5505 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5507 unblock_input ();
5510 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5512 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5513 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5515 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5516 mark bits. */
5519 static void
5520 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event, struct input_event *emacs_event)
5522 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
5523 emacs_abort ();
5525 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5526 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5527 emacs_event->modifiers
5528 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5529 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5530 event->xbutton.state)
5531 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5532 ? up_modifier
5533 : down_modifier));
5534 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5535 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5536 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5538 int top_range
5539 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5540 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5542 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5543 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5545 if (y < bar->start)
5546 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5547 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5548 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5549 else
5550 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5552 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5553 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5554 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5555 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5557 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5558 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5560 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5561 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5563 #endif
5565 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5566 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5570 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5572 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5574 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5575 mark bits. */
5577 static void
5578 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5580 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5582 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5584 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5585 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5587 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5588 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5590 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5591 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5593 if (new_start != bar->start)
5595 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5597 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5602 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5604 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5605 on the scroll bar. */
5607 static void
5608 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (FRAME_PTR *fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
5609 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x,
5610 Lisp_Object *y, Time *timestamp)
5612 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5613 Window w = bar->x_window;
5614 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5615 int win_x, win_y;
5616 Window dummy_window;
5617 int dummy_coord;
5618 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5620 block_input ();
5622 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5623 report that. */
5624 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5626 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5627 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5628 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5630 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5631 &win_x, &win_y,
5633 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5634 &dummy_mask))
5636 else
5638 int top_range
5639 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5641 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5643 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5644 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5646 if (win_y < 0)
5647 win_y = 0;
5648 if (win_y > top_range)
5649 win_y = top_range;
5651 *fp = f;
5652 *bar_window = bar->window;
5654 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5655 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5656 else if (win_y < bar->start)
5657 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5658 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5659 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5660 else
5661 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5663 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5664 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5666 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5667 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5670 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
5672 unblock_input ();
5676 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5677 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5678 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5679 redraw them. */
5681 static void
5682 x_scroll_bar_clear (FRAME_PTR f)
5684 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5685 Lisp_Object bar;
5687 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5688 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5689 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5690 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5691 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5692 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5693 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5694 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
5695 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5696 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5700 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5702 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5703 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5704 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5705 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5707 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5708 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5710 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5712 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5713 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5715 static int temp_index;
5716 static short temp_buffer[100];
5718 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5719 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5720 temp_index = 0; \
5721 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5723 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5724 on a particular display. */
5726 static struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5728 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5729 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5730 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5731 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5733 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5735 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || defined USE_GTK
5736 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT \
5737 do \
5739 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5740 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = \
5741 xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5742 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = event; \
5743 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5744 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5746 while (0)
5747 #endif
5749 enum
5751 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5752 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5753 X_EVENT_DROP
5756 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5757 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5758 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5760 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5761 this event further.
5762 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5764 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5765 static int
5766 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event)
5768 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5769 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5770 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5771 was created. */
5773 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5774 event->xclient.window);
5776 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5778 #endif
5780 #ifdef USE_GTK
5781 static int current_count;
5782 static int current_finish;
5783 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5785 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5786 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5787 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5788 static GdkFilterReturn
5789 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent *gxev, GdkEvent *ev, gpointer data)
5791 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5793 block_input ();
5794 if (current_count >= 0)
5796 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5798 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5800 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5801 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5802 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5803 so we do it here. */
5804 if ((xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5805 && dpyinfo
5806 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5808 unblock_input ();
5809 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5811 #endif
5813 if (! dpyinfo)
5814 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5815 else
5816 current_count +=
5817 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5818 current_hold_quit);
5820 else
5821 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5823 unblock_input ();
5825 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5826 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5828 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5830 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5833 static void xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time,
5834 enum xembed_message,
5835 long detail, long data1, long data2);
5837 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5839 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5840 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5841 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5843 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5845 static int
5846 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *eventptr,
5847 int *finish, struct input_event *hold_quit)
5849 union {
5850 struct input_event ie;
5851 struct selection_input_event sie;
5852 } inev;
5853 int count = 0;
5854 int do_help = 0;
5855 ptrdiff_t nbytes = 0;
5856 struct frame *f = NULL;
5857 struct coding_system coding;
5858 XEvent event = *eventptr;
5859 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
5860 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
5862 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5864 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5865 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5866 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5868 if (pending_event_wait.eventtype == event.type)
5869 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
5871 switch (event.type)
5873 case ClientMessage:
5875 if (event.xclient.message_type
5876 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5877 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5879 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5880 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5882 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5883 could be the shell widget window
5884 if the frame has no title bar. */
5885 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5886 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5887 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5888 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5889 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5890 #endif
5891 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5892 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5893 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5894 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5895 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5896 needed.
5898 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5899 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5900 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5901 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5902 Emacs. */
5904 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5905 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5906 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5907 if (f)
5909 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5910 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5911 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5912 x_catch_errors (d);
5913 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5914 /* The ICCCM says this is
5915 the only valid choice. */
5916 RevertToParent,
5917 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5918 /* This is needed to detect the error
5919 if there is an error. */
5920 XSync (d, False);
5921 x_uncatch_errors ();
5923 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5924 #endif /* 0 */
5925 goto done;
5928 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5929 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5931 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5932 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5933 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5934 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5935 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5936 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5937 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5938 session manager and one for this. */
5939 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5940 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5941 #endif
5943 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5944 event.xclient.window);
5945 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5946 for a single Emacs process. */
5947 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5948 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5949 event.xclient.window,
5950 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5951 else if (f)
5952 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5953 event.xclient.window,
5954 0, 0);
5956 goto done;
5959 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5960 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5962 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5963 event.xclient.window);
5964 if (!f)
5965 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5967 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5968 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5969 goto done;
5972 goto done;
5975 if (event.xclient.message_type
5976 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5978 goto done;
5981 if (event.xclient.message_type
5982 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5984 int new_x, new_y;
5985 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5987 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5988 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5990 if (f)
5992 f->left_pos = new_x;
5993 f->top_pos = new_y;
5995 goto done;
5998 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5999 if (event.xclient.message_type
6000 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
6002 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6003 if (f)
6004 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
6005 &event, NULL);
6006 goto done;
6008 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
6010 if ((event.xclient.message_type
6011 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
6012 || (event.xclient.message_type
6013 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
6015 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
6016 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
6017 currently never do because we are interested in
6018 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
6019 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
6020 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6021 if (!f)
6022 goto OTHER;
6023 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
6024 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
6025 goto done;
6028 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6029 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
6030 we construct an input_event. */
6031 if (event.xclient.message_type
6032 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
6034 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
6035 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6036 goto done;
6038 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6040 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
6041 if (event.xclient.message_type
6042 == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
6044 enum xembed_message msg = event.xclient.data.l[1];
6045 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
6046 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6048 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6049 goto done;
6052 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6054 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6055 if (!f)
6056 goto OTHER;
6057 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
6058 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6060 break;
6062 case SelectionNotify:
6063 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
6064 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6065 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
6066 goto OTHER;
6067 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6068 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
6069 break;
6071 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6072 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
6073 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6074 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
6075 goto OTHER;
6076 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6078 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionclear);
6080 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
6081 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6082 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6083 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6085 break;
6087 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6088 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
6089 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6090 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
6091 goto OTHER;
6092 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6094 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionrequest);
6096 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
6097 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6098 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
6099 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6100 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
6101 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
6102 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6104 break;
6106 case PropertyNotify:
6107 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
6108 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window);
6109 if (f && event.xproperty.atom == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state)
6110 if (x_handle_net_wm_state (f, &event.xproperty) && f->iconified
6111 && f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen)
6113 /* Gnome shell does not iconify us when C-z is pressed. It hides
6114 the frame. So if our state says we aren't hidden anymore,
6115 treat it as deiconified. */
6116 if (! f->async_iconified)
6117 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6118 f->async_visible = 1;
6119 f->async_iconified = 0;
6120 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6121 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 0;
6122 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6123 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6126 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
6127 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6128 goto OTHER;
6130 case ReparentNotify:
6131 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
6132 if (f)
6134 int x, y;
6135 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
6136 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
6137 f->left_pos = x;
6138 f->top_pos = y;
6140 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6141 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6142 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
6144 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
6146 goto OTHER;
6148 case Expose:
6149 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
6150 if (f)
6152 #ifdef USE_GTK
6153 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6154 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
6155 event.xexpose.window,
6156 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6157 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
6158 FALSE);
6159 #endif
6160 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6162 f->async_visible = 1;
6163 f->async_iconified = 0;
6164 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6165 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6167 else
6168 expose_frame (f,
6169 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6170 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6172 else
6174 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6175 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6176 #endif
6177 #if defined USE_LUCID
6178 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6179 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6180 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6182 Widget widget
6183 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6184 if (widget)
6185 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6187 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6189 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6190 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6191 goto OTHER;
6192 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6193 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6194 event.xexpose.window);
6196 if (bar)
6197 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6198 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6199 else
6200 goto OTHER;
6201 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6202 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6204 break;
6206 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6207 source area was obscured or not
6208 available. */
6209 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6210 if (f)
6212 expose_frame (f,
6213 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6214 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6215 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6217 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6218 else
6219 goto OTHER;
6220 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6221 break;
6223 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6224 source area was completely
6225 available. */
6226 break;
6228 case UnmapNotify:
6229 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6230 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6232 tip_window = 0;
6233 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6236 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6237 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6238 the frame was deleted. */
6240 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6241 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6242 display that won't ever be seen. */
6243 f->async_visible = 0;
6244 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6245 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6246 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6247 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6248 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6249 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6250 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6252 f->async_iconified = 1;
6254 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6255 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6258 goto OTHER;
6260 case MapNotify:
6261 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6262 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6263 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6264 goto OTHER;
6266 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6267 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6268 frame is visible. */
6269 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6270 if (f)
6272 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6273 the frame's display structures.
6274 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6275 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6276 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6277 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6278 if (! f->async_iconified)
6279 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6281 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
6282 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
6283 if (!f->output_data.x->has_been_visible)
6284 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6286 f->async_visible = 1;
6287 f->async_iconified = 0;
6288 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6290 if (f->iconified)
6292 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6293 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6295 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6296 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6297 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6298 to update the frame titles
6299 in case this is the second frame. */
6300 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6302 #ifdef USE_GTK
6303 xg_frame_resized (f, -1, -1);
6304 #endif
6306 goto OTHER;
6308 case KeyPress:
6310 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6311 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6313 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6314 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6315 if (popup_activated ())
6316 goto OTHER;
6317 #endif
6319 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6321 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6322 mouse highlighting. */
6323 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6324 && (f == 0
6325 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6327 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6328 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6331 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6332 if (f == 0)
6334 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6335 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6336 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6337 event.xkey.window);
6338 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6340 widget = XtParent (widget);
6341 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6344 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6346 if (f != 0)
6348 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6349 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6350 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6351 his Emacs hang.
6353 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6354 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6355 status_return even if the input is too long to
6356 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6357 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6358 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6359 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6360 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6361 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6362 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6363 int modifiers;
6364 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6365 Lisp_Object c;
6367 #ifdef USE_GTK
6368 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6369 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6370 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6371 (see above). */
6372 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6373 #endif
6375 event.xkey.state
6376 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6377 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6378 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6380 /* This will have to go some day... */
6382 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6383 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6384 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6385 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6386 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6387 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6388 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6390 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6391 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6392 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6393 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6394 not it is combined with Meta. */
6395 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6396 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6398 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6399 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6401 Status status_return;
6403 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6404 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6405 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6406 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6407 &status_return);
6408 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6410 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6411 copy_bufptr = alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6412 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6413 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6414 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6415 &status_return);
6417 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6418 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6419 break;
6420 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6422 keysym = NoSymbol;
6423 modifiers = 0;
6425 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6426 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6427 emacs_abort ();
6429 else
6430 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6431 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6432 &compose_status);
6433 #else
6434 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6435 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6436 &compose_status);
6437 #endif
6439 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6440 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6441 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6442 break;
6444 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6445 orig_keysym = keysym;
6447 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6448 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6449 inev.ie.modifiers
6450 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6451 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6453 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6454 translations to characters. */
6455 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6456 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6458 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6459 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6460 goto done_keysym;
6463 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6464 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
6466 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
6467 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6468 else
6469 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6470 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
6471 goto done_keysym;
6474 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6475 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6476 && (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6477 Vx_keysym_table,
6478 Qnil),
6479 NATNUMP (c)))
6481 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6482 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6483 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6484 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6485 goto done_keysym;
6488 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6489 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6490 || keysym == XK_Delete
6491 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6492 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6493 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6494 #endif
6495 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6496 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6497 #ifdef HPUX
6498 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6499 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6500 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6501 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6502 || (XK_Select <= keysym && keysym < XK_KP_Space)
6503 #endif
6504 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6505 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6506 #endif
6507 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6508 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6509 #endif
6510 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6511 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6512 #endif
6513 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6514 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6515 #endif
6516 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6517 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6518 #endif
6519 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6520 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6521 #endif
6522 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6523 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6524 #endif
6525 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6526 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6527 #endif
6528 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6529 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6530 #endif
6531 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6532 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6533 #endif
6534 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6535 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6536 #endif
6537 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6538 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6539 #endif
6540 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6541 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6542 #endif
6543 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6544 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6545 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6546 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6547 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6548 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6549 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6550 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6551 don't have real modifiers but
6552 should be treated similarly to
6553 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6554 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6555 || (XK_ISO_Lock <= orig_keysym
6556 && orig_keysym <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6557 #endif
6560 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6561 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6562 key. */
6563 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6564 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6565 goto done_keysym;
6568 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6569 ptrdiff_t i;
6570 int nchars, len;
6572 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6574 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
6575 nchars++;
6576 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6579 if (nchars < nbytes)
6581 /* Decode the input data. */
6583 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6584 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6585 we used just above and the locale. */
6586 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6587 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6588 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6589 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6590 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6591 gives us composition information. */
6592 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
6594 SAFE_NALLOCA (coding.destination, MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH,
6595 nbytes);
6596 coding.dst_bytes = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
6597 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6598 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
6599 nbytes = coding.produced;
6600 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6601 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
6604 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6605 character events. */
6606 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6608 int ch;
6609 if (nchars == nbytes)
6610 ch = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6611 else
6612 ch = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i, len);
6613 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (ch)
6614 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6615 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6616 inev.ie.code = ch;
6617 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6620 count += nchars;
6622 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6624 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6625 break;
6628 done_keysym:
6629 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6630 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6631 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6632 client. */
6633 break;
6634 #else
6635 goto OTHER;
6636 #endif
6638 case KeyRelease:
6639 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6640 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6641 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6642 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6643 client. */
6644 break;
6645 #else
6646 goto OTHER;
6647 #endif
6649 case EnterNotify:
6650 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6651 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6653 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6655 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6656 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6658 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6659 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6660 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6661 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6662 #ifdef USE_GTK
6663 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6664 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6665 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6666 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6667 #endif
6668 goto OTHER;
6670 case FocusIn:
6671 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6672 goto OTHER;
6674 case LeaveNotify:
6675 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6676 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6678 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6679 if (f)
6681 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6683 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6684 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6685 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6686 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6689 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6690 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6691 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6692 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6693 if (any_help_event_p)
6694 do_help = -1;
6696 #ifdef USE_GTK
6697 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6698 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6699 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6700 #endif
6701 goto OTHER;
6703 case FocusOut:
6704 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6705 goto OTHER;
6707 case MotionNotify:
6709 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6710 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6711 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6713 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6714 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6715 f = last_mouse_frame;
6716 else
6717 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6719 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6721 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6722 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6725 #ifdef USE_GTK
6726 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6727 f = 0;
6728 #endif
6729 if (f)
6732 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
6733 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
6734 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window) && !popup_activated ())
6736 Lisp_Object window;
6738 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6739 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6740 0, 0);
6742 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6743 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6744 will be selected only when it is active. */
6745 if (WINDOWP (window)
6746 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6747 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6748 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6749 create event iff we don't leave the
6750 selected frame. */
6751 && (focus_follows_mouse
6752 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
6753 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
6755 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6756 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6759 last_window=window;
6761 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6762 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6764 else
6766 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6767 struct scroll_bar *bar
6768 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6769 event.xmotion.window);
6771 if (bar)
6772 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6773 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6775 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6776 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6777 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6780 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6781 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6782 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6783 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6784 do_help = 1;
6785 goto OTHER;
6788 case ConfigureNotify:
6789 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6790 #ifdef USE_GTK
6791 if (!f
6792 && (f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window))
6793 && event.xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
6795 xg_frame_resized (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6796 event.xconfigure.height);
6797 f = 0;
6799 #endif
6800 if (f)
6802 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6803 #ifndef USE_GTK
6804 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6805 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6807 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6808 is called by the code that handles resizing
6809 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6811 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6812 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6813 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6814 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6815 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6816 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6817 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6819 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6820 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6821 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6824 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6825 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6826 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6827 #endif
6829 #ifdef USE_GTK
6830 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6831 Only get real positions when mapped. */
6832 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6833 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6834 #endif
6836 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6839 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6840 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6841 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6842 #endif
6845 goto OTHER;
6847 case ButtonRelease:
6848 case ButtonPress:
6850 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6851 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6852 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6854 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6855 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6856 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
6858 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6859 && last_mouse_frame
6860 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6861 f = last_mouse_frame;
6862 else
6863 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6865 #ifdef USE_GTK
6866 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6867 f = 0;
6868 #endif
6869 if (f)
6871 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6872 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6873 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6875 Lisp_Object window;
6876 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6877 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6879 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 1);
6880 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
6882 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
6884 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y,
6885 event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
6886 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6887 event.xbutton.state));
6891 if (!tool_bar_p)
6892 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6893 if (! popup_activated ())
6894 #endif
6896 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6898 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6899 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6901 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6902 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6904 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6905 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6907 else
6908 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6910 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
6911 xembed_send_message (f, event.xbutton.time,
6912 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
6914 else
6916 struct scroll_bar *bar
6917 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6918 event.xbutton.window);
6920 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6921 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6922 scroll bars. */
6923 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6925 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6926 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6928 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6929 if (bar)
6930 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6931 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6934 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6936 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6937 last_mouse_frame = f;
6939 if (!tool_bar_p)
6940 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6942 else
6943 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6945 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6946 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6947 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6948 if (f != 0)
6949 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6951 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6952 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, &event);
6953 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6954 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6955 Instead, save it away
6956 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6957 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6958 if (! popup_activated ()
6959 #ifdef USE_GTK
6960 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
6961 && event.xbutton.button < 3
6962 #endif
6963 && f && event.type == ButtonPress
6964 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6965 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6966 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6967 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6968 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6969 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6970 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6972 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6973 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6974 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6976 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6978 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6979 goto OTHER;
6981 else
6982 goto OTHER;
6983 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6985 break;
6987 case CirculateNotify:
6988 goto OTHER;
6990 case CirculateRequest:
6991 goto OTHER;
6993 case VisibilityNotify:
6994 goto OTHER;
6996 case MappingNotify:
6997 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6998 local cache. */
6999 switch (event.xmapping.request)
7001 case MappingModifier:
7002 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
7003 /* This is meant to fall through. */
7004 case MappingKeyboard:
7005 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
7007 goto OTHER;
7009 case DestroyNotify:
7010 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
7011 break;
7013 default:
7014 OTHER:
7015 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7016 block_input ();
7017 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
7018 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
7019 unblock_input ();
7020 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7021 break;
7024 done:
7025 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
7027 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
7028 count++;
7031 if (do_help
7032 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
7034 Lisp_Object frame;
7036 if (f)
7037 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
7038 else
7039 frame = Qnil;
7041 if (do_help > 0)
7043 any_help_event_p = 1;
7044 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
7045 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
7047 else
7049 help_echo_string = Qnil;
7050 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
7052 count++;
7055 SAFE_FREE ();
7056 *eventptr = event;
7057 return count;
7060 #if defined USE_GTK || defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
7062 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
7063 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
7064 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
7066 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
7068 x_dispatch_event (XEvent *event, Display *display)
7070 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7071 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
7073 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
7075 if (dpyinfo)
7076 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
7078 return finish;
7080 #endif
7083 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7084 Return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7086 Return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7087 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7088 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7089 C chars). */
7091 static int
7092 XTread_socket (struct terminal *terminal, struct input_event *hold_quit)
7094 int count = 0;
7095 int event_found = 0;
7097 block_input ();
7099 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7100 input_signal_count++;
7102 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7103 if (terminal->display_info.x == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7105 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7106 x_io_error_quitter (terminal->display_info.x->display);
7109 #ifndef USE_GTK
7110 while (XPending (terminal->display_info.x->display))
7112 int finish;
7113 XEvent event;
7115 XNextEvent (terminal->display_info.x->display, &event);
7117 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7118 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7119 if (x_filter_event (terminal->display_info.x, &event))
7120 continue;
7121 #endif
7122 event_found = 1;
7124 count += handle_one_xevent (terminal->display_info.x,
7125 &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7127 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7128 goto out;
7131 out:;
7133 #else /* USE_GTK */
7135 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7136 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7137 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7138 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7140 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7141 from all displays. */
7143 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7145 current_count = count;
7146 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7148 gtk_main_iteration ();
7150 count = current_count;
7151 current_count = -1;
7152 current_hold_quit = 0;
7154 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7155 break;
7157 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7159 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7160 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7161 if (! event_found)
7163 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7164 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7165 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7166 x_noop_count++;
7167 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7169 x_noop_count=0;
7171 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7172 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7174 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7176 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7177 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7181 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7182 raise it now. */
7183 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7184 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7186 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7187 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7190 unblock_input ();
7192 return count;
7198 /***********************************************************************
7199 Text Cursor
7200 ***********************************************************************/
7202 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7203 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7205 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7206 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7207 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7209 static void
7210 x_clip_to_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int area, GC gc)
7212 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7213 XRectangle clip_rect;
7214 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7216 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7218 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7219 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7220 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7221 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7222 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7224 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7228 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7230 static void
7231 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
7233 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7234 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7235 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7236 int x, y, wd, h;
7237 XGCValues xgcv;
7238 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7239 GC gc;
7241 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7242 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7243 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7244 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7245 return;
7247 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7248 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7249 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7251 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7252 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7253 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7254 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7255 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7256 else
7257 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7258 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7259 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7261 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7262 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7263 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7264 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7268 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7270 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7271 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7272 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7273 --gerd. */
7275 static void
7276 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int width, enum text_cursor_kinds kind)
7278 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7279 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7281 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7282 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7283 and mini-buffer. */
7284 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7285 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7286 return;
7287 #ifdef HAVE_XWIDGETS
7288 if (cursor_glyph->type == XWIDGET_GLYPH){
7289 printf("tried avoiding xwidget cursor\n");
7290 return; //experimental avoidance of cursor on xwidget
7292 #endif
7293 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7294 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7295 the bar might not be in the window. */
7296 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7298 struct glyph_row *r;
7299 r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7300 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, r, DRAW_CURSOR);
7302 else
7304 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7305 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7306 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7307 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7308 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7309 XGCValues xgcv;
7311 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7312 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7313 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7314 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7315 that the glyph is legible. */
7316 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7317 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7318 else
7319 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7320 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7322 if (gc)
7323 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7324 else
7326 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7327 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7330 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7332 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7334 int x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7336 if (width < 0)
7337 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7338 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7340 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7342 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
7343 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
7344 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0)
7345 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - width;
7347 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc, x,
7348 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7349 width, row->height);
7351 else
7353 int dummy_x, dummy_y, dummy_h;
7355 if (width < 0)
7356 width = row->height;
7358 width = min (row->height, width);
7360 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &dummy_x,
7361 &dummy_y, &dummy_h);
7363 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7364 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7365 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7366 row->height - width),
7367 w->phys_cursor_width, width);
7370 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7375 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7377 static void
7378 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor)
7380 if (!f->pointer_invisible
7381 && f->output_data.x->current_cursor != cursor)
7382 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7383 f->output_data.x->current_cursor = cursor;
7387 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7389 static void
7390 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height)
7392 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7393 x, y, width, height, False);
7394 #ifdef USE_GTK
7395 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
7396 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
7397 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
7398 #endif
7402 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7404 static void
7405 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *glyph_row, int x, int y, int cursor_type, int cursor_width, int on_p, int active_p)
7407 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7409 if (on_p)
7411 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7412 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7414 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7415 && (glyph_row->reversed_p
7416 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
7417 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
7419 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7420 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, glyph_row->reversed_p);
7422 else
7424 switch (cursor_type)
7426 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7427 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7428 break;
7430 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7431 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7432 break;
7434 case BAR_CURSOR:
7435 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7436 break;
7438 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7439 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7440 break;
7442 case NO_CURSOR:
7443 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7444 break;
7446 default:
7447 emacs_abort ();
7451 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7452 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7453 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7454 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7455 #endif
7458 #ifndef XFlush
7459 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7460 #endif
7464 /* Icons. */
7466 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7469 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object file)
7471 ptrdiff_t bitmap_id;
7473 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7474 return 1;
7476 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7477 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7478 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7479 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7481 if (STRINGP (file))
7483 #ifdef USE_GTK
7484 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7485 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7486 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7487 return 0;
7488 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7489 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7490 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7492 else
7494 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7495 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7497 ptrdiff_t rc = -1;
7499 #ifdef USE_GTK
7501 if (xg_set_icon (f, xg_default_icon_file)
7502 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7503 return 0;
7505 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7507 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7508 if (rc != -1)
7509 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7511 #endif
7513 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7514 if (rc == -1)
7516 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, (char *) gnu_xbm_bits,
7517 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7518 if (rc == -1)
7519 return 1;
7521 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7522 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7526 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7527 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7528 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7529 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7530 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7532 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7535 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7536 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7538 return 0;
7542 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7543 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7546 x_text_icon (struct frame *f, const char *icon_name)
7548 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7549 return 1;
7552 XTextProperty text;
7553 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7554 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7555 text.format = 8;
7556 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7557 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7560 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7561 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7562 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7563 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7565 return 0;
7568 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7570 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7571 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7573 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7574 be called from a signal handler.
7577 struct x_error_message_stack {
7578 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7579 Display *dpy;
7580 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7582 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7584 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7585 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7586 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7588 static void
7589 x_error_catcher (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7591 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code,
7592 x_error_message->string,
7593 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7596 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7597 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7598 operating on.
7600 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7601 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7602 stored in *x_error_message.
7604 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7605 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7607 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7609 void
7610 x_catch_errors (Display *dpy)
7612 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof *data);
7614 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7615 XSync (dpy, False);
7617 data->dpy = dpy;
7618 data->string[0] = 0;
7619 data->prev = x_error_message;
7620 x_error_message = data;
7623 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7624 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7626 void
7627 x_uncatch_errors (void)
7629 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7631 block_input ();
7633 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7634 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7635 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7636 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7638 tmp = x_error_message;
7639 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7640 xfree (tmp);
7641 unblock_input ();
7644 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7645 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7646 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7648 void
7649 x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format)
7651 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7652 XSync (dpy, False);
7654 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7656 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7657 memcpy (string, x_error_message->string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7658 x_uncatch_errors ();
7659 error (format, string);
7663 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7664 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7667 x_had_errors_p (Display *dpy)
7669 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7670 XSync (dpy, False);
7672 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7675 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7677 void
7678 x_clear_errors (Display *dpy)
7680 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7683 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7684 * idea. --lorentey */
7685 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7687 void
7688 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
7690 while (x_error_message)
7691 x_uncatch_errors ();
7693 #endif
7695 #if 0
7696 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7697 x_trace_wire (void)
7699 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7701 #endif /* ! 0 */
7704 /************************************************************************
7705 Handling X errors
7706 ************************************************************************/
7708 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7710 static char *error_msg;
7712 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7713 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7715 static void
7716 x_connection_closed (Display *dpy, const char *error_message)
7718 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7719 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7720 ptrdiff_t idx = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7722 error_msg = alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7723 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7725 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7726 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
7728 if (dpyinfo)
7730 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7731 frame on it. */
7732 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
7733 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
7736 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7737 that are on the dead display. */
7738 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7740 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7741 minibuf_frame
7742 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7743 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7744 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7745 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7746 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7747 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7750 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7751 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7752 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7753 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7754 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7755 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7757 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
7758 trying to find a replacement. */
7759 kset_default_minibuffer_frame (FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame)), Qt);
7760 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7763 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display in the
7764 first place, so don't try to close it. */
7765 if (dpyinfo)
7767 /* We can not call XtCloseDisplay here because it calls XSync.
7768 XSync inside the error handler apparently hangs Emacs. On
7769 current Xt versions, this isn't needed either. */
7770 #ifdef USE_GTK
7771 /* A long-standing GTK bug prevents proper disconnect handling
7772 (https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). Once,
7773 the resulting Glib error message loop filled a user's disk.
7774 To avoid this, kill Emacs unconditionally on disconnect. */
7775 shut_down_emacs (0, Qnil);
7776 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n\
7777 When compiled with GTK, Emacs cannot recover from X disconnects.\n\
7778 This is a GTK bug: https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715\n\
7779 For details, see etc/PROBLEMS.\n",
7780 error_msg);
7781 emacs_abort ();
7782 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7784 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7785 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7787 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
7788 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
7789 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
7790 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7791 emacs_abort ();
7794 Lisp_Object tmp;
7795 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
7796 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
7800 if (terminal_list == 0)
7802 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7803 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7804 /* NOTREACHED */
7807 totally_unblock_input ();
7809 unbind_to (idx, Qnil);
7810 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7812 /* Tell GCC not to suggest attribute 'noreturn' for this function. */
7813 IF_LINT (if (! terminal_list) return; )
7815 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
7816 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
7817 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
7818 error ("%s", error_msg);
7821 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7822 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7823 static void x_error_quitter (Display *, XErrorEvent *);
7825 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7826 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7828 static int
7829 x_error_handler (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7831 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
7832 if (event->error_code == BadMatch
7833 && event->request_code == X_SetInputFocus
7834 && event->minor_code == 0)
7836 return 0;
7838 #endif
7840 if (x_error_message)
7841 x_error_catcher (display, event);
7842 else
7843 x_error_quitter (display, event);
7844 return 0;
7847 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7848 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7849 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7851 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7853 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7854 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7856 static void NO_INLINE
7857 x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7859 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7861 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7862 or colors that are not defined. */
7864 if (event->error_code == BadName)
7865 return;
7867 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7868 original error handler. */
7870 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7871 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7872 buf, event->request_code);
7873 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7877 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7878 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7879 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7881 static int
7882 x_io_error_quitter (Display *display)
7884 char buf[256];
7886 snprintf (buf, sizeof buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'",
7887 DisplayString (display));
7888 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7889 return 0;
7892 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7894 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
7895 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
7896 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
7897 FONT-OBJECT. */
7899 Lisp_Object
7900 x_new_font (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object font_object, int fontset)
7902 struct font *font = XFONT_OBJECT (font_object);
7904 if (fontset < 0)
7905 fontset = fontset_from_font (font_object);
7906 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7907 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == font)
7908 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
7909 do. */
7910 return font_object;
7912 FRAME_FONT (f) = font;
7913 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->baseline_offset;
7914 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->average_width;
7915 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
7917 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7919 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7920 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7922 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7923 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7924 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7926 else
7928 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7929 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7932 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7934 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7935 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7936 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7937 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7938 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7941 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7942 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7943 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7945 block_input ();
7946 xic_set_xfontset (f, SSDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7947 unblock_input ();
7949 #endif
7951 return font_object;
7955 /***********************************************************************
7956 X Input Methods
7957 ***********************************************************************/
7959 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7961 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7963 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7964 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7965 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7967 static void
7968 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
7970 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7971 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7973 block_input ();
7975 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7976 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7978 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7979 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
7981 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
7982 xic_free_xfontset (f);
7986 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7987 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7988 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
7989 unblock_input ();
7992 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
7994 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7995 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
7996 extern char *XSetIMValues (XIM, ...);
7997 #endif
7999 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8000 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
8002 static void
8003 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8005 XIM xim;
8007 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8008 if (use_xim)
8010 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8011 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8012 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8013 emacs_class);
8014 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8016 if (xim)
8018 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8019 XIMCallback destroy;
8020 #endif
8022 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8023 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8025 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8026 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8027 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8028 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8029 #endif
8033 else
8034 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8035 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8039 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8041 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8042 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8043 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8044 when the callback was registered. */
8046 static void
8047 xim_instantiate_callback (Display *display, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8049 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8050 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8052 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8053 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8054 return;
8056 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8058 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8059 as they have no XIC. */
8060 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8062 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8064 block_input ();
8065 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8067 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8069 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
8070 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8071 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8073 create_frame_xic (f);
8074 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8075 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8076 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8078 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8079 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8084 unblock_input ();
8088 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8091 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8092 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8093 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8094 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8096 static void
8097 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8099 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8100 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8101 if (use_xim)
8103 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8104 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = xmalloc (sizeof *xim_inst);
8105 ptrdiff_t len;
8107 dpyinfo->xim_callback_data = xim_inst;
8108 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8109 len = strlen (resource_name);
8110 xim_inst->resource_name = xmalloc (len + 1);
8111 memcpy (xim_inst->resource_name, resource_name, len + 1);
8112 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8113 resource_name, emacs_class,
8114 xim_instantiate_callback,
8115 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8116 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8117 least, hence the configure test. */
8118 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8119 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8120 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8121 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8123 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8127 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8129 static void
8130 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
8132 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8133 if (use_xim)
8135 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8136 if (dpyinfo->display)
8137 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8138 NULL, emacs_class,
8139 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8140 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data->resource_name);
8141 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data);
8142 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8143 if (dpyinfo->display)
8144 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8145 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8146 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8148 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8151 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8155 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8156 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8158 static void
8159 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame *f)
8161 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8163 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8164 is already for the top-left corner. */
8165 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8166 return;
8168 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8169 position that fits on the screen. */
8170 if (flags & XNegative)
8171 f->left_pos = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8172 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos;
8175 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8177 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8178 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8179 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8181 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8182 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8183 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8184 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8185 is right, though.
8187 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8188 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8190 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8191 #endif
8193 if (flags & YNegative)
8194 f->top_pos = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8195 - height + f->top_pos;
8198 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8199 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8200 so the flags should correspond. */
8201 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8204 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8205 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8206 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8207 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8208 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8210 void
8211 x_set_offset (struct frame *f, register int xoff, register int yoff, int change_gravity)
8213 int modified_top, modified_left;
8215 if (change_gravity > 0)
8217 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8218 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8220 f->top_pos = yoff;
8221 f->left_pos = xoff;
8222 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8223 if (xoff < 0)
8224 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8225 if (yoff < 0)
8226 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8227 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8229 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8231 block_input ();
8232 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8234 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8235 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8237 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8239 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8240 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8241 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8242 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8243 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8246 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8247 modified_left, modified_top);
8249 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8250 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8251 ? 1 : 0);
8253 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8254 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8255 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8256 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8257 of the frame.
8259 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8260 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8261 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8263 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8264 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8265 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8266 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8267 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8268 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8270 unblock_input ();
8273 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8274 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8275 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8276 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8277 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8279 static int
8280 wm_supports (struct frame *f, Atom want_atom)
8282 Atom actual_type;
8283 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8284 int i, rc, actual_format;
8285 Window wmcheck_window;
8286 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8287 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8288 long max_len = 65536;
8289 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8290 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8291 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8293 block_input ();
8295 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8296 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8297 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check,
8298 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8299 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8300 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8302 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8304 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8305 x_uncatch_errors ();
8306 unblock_input ();
8307 return 0;
8310 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8311 XFree (tmp_data);
8313 /* Check if window exists. */
8314 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8315 x_sync (f);
8316 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8318 x_uncatch_errors ();
8319 unblock_input ();
8320 return 0;
8323 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8325 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8326 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8327 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8328 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8329 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8330 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8332 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8333 tmp_data = NULL;
8334 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8335 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported,
8336 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8337 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8338 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8340 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8342 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8343 x_uncatch_errors ();
8344 unblock_input ();
8345 return 0;
8348 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8349 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8350 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8353 rc = 0;
8355 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8356 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8358 x_uncatch_errors ();
8359 unblock_input ();
8361 return rc;
8364 static void
8365 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame, int add, Atom atom, Atom value)
8367 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame));
8369 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8370 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8371 make_number (32),
8372 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
8373 Fcons
8374 (make_number (add ? 1 : 0),
8375 Fcons
8376 (make_fixnum_or_float (atom),
8377 value != 0
8378 ? Fcons (make_fixnum_or_float (value), Qnil)
8379 : Qnil)));
8382 void
8383 x_set_sticky (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object new_value, Lisp_Object old_value)
8385 Lisp_Object frame;
8386 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8388 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8390 set_wm_state (frame, NILP (new_value) ? 0 : 1,
8391 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky, None);
8394 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
8395 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
8396 STICKY is set to 1 if the sticky state is set, 0 if not.
8398 Return non-zero if we are not hidden, zero if we are. */
8400 static int
8401 get_current_wm_state (struct frame *f,
8402 Window window,
8403 int *size_state,
8404 int *sticky)
8406 Atom actual_type;
8407 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8408 int i, rc, actual_format, is_hidden = 0;
8409 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8410 long max_len = 65536;
8411 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8412 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8413 Atom target_type = XA_ATOM;
8415 *sticky = 0;
8416 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8418 block_input ();
8419 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8420 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, window, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8421 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8422 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8423 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8425 if (rc != Success || actual_type != target_type || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8427 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8428 x_uncatch_errors ();
8429 unblock_input ();
8430 return ! f->iconified;
8433 x_uncatch_errors ();
8435 for (i = 0; i < actual_size; ++i)
8437 Atom a = ((Atom*)tmp_data)[i];
8438 if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden)
8440 is_hidden = 1;
8441 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 1;
8443 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
8445 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8446 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8447 else
8448 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_WIDTH;
8450 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
8452 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
8453 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8454 else
8455 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT;
8457 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen)
8458 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_BOTH;
8459 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
8460 *sticky = 1;
8463 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8464 unblock_input ();
8465 return ! is_hidden;
8468 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8470 static int
8471 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8473 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8474 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state);
8475 int cur, dummy;
8477 (void)get_current_wm_state (f, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &cur, &dummy);
8479 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8480 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8481 if (!have_net_atom)
8482 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen);
8484 if (have_net_atom && cur != f->want_fullscreen)
8486 Lisp_Object frame;
8488 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8490 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
8491 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
8492 are sent at once. */
8493 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8495 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8496 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
8497 || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8498 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8499 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8500 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8501 break;
8502 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8503 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
8504 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8505 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8506 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8507 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8508 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz, None);
8509 break;
8510 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8511 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
8512 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8513 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8514 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz);
8515 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8516 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert, None);
8517 break;
8518 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8519 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8520 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8521 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8522 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8523 break;
8524 case FULLSCREEN_NONE:
8525 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8526 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8527 else
8528 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8529 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8532 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8536 return have_net_atom;
8539 static void
8540 XTfullscreen_hook (FRAME_PTR f)
8542 if (f->async_visible)
8544 block_input ();
8545 x_check_fullscreen (f);
8546 x_sync (f);
8547 unblock_input ();
8552 static int
8553 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, XPropertyEvent *event)
8555 int value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8556 Lisp_Object lval;
8557 int sticky = 0;
8558 int not_hidden = get_current_wm_state (f, event->window, &value, &sticky);
8560 lval = Qnil;
8561 switch (value)
8563 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8564 lval = Qfullwidth;
8565 break;
8566 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8567 lval = Qfullheight;
8568 break;
8569 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8570 lval = Qfullboth;
8571 break;
8572 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8573 lval = Qmaximized;
8574 break;
8577 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
8578 store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil);
8580 return not_hidden;
8583 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8584 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8585 static void
8586 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8588 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8589 return;
8591 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8592 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
8594 /* Setting fullscreen to nil doesn't do anything. We could save the
8595 last non-fullscreen size and restore it, but it seems like a
8596 lot of work for this unusual case (no window manager running). */
8598 if (f->want_fullscreen != FULLSCREEN_NONE)
8600 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8601 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8603 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8605 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
8606 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8607 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8608 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8609 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8610 break;
8611 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8612 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8613 break;
8614 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8615 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8618 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8619 width, height);
8623 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8624 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8625 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8626 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8627 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8628 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8629 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8631 static void
8632 x_check_expected_move (struct frame *f, int expected_left, int expected_top)
8634 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8636 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8637 window manager window around the frame. */
8639 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8641 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8643 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8645 int adjusted_left;
8646 int adjusted_top;
8648 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8649 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8650 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8652 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8654 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8655 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8657 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8658 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8660 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8662 else
8663 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8664 frame's position. */
8666 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8670 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8671 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8672 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8673 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8674 of an exact comparison. */
8676 static void
8677 x_sync_with_move (struct frame *f, int left, int top, int fuzzy)
8679 int count = 0;
8681 while (count++ < 50)
8683 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8685 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8686 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8687 loop. */
8689 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8690 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8692 if (fuzzy)
8694 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8695 pixels. */
8697 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
8698 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8699 return;
8701 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8702 return;
8705 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8706 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8708 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8712 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
8713 void
8714 x_wait_for_event (struct frame *f, int eventtype)
8716 int level = interrupt_input_blocked;
8718 SELECT_TYPE fds;
8719 EMACS_TIME tmo, tmo_at, time_now;
8720 int fd = ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8722 pending_event_wait.f = f;
8723 pending_event_wait.eventtype = eventtype;
8725 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticeable.
8726 Maybe it should be configurable. */
8727 tmo = make_emacs_time (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
8728 tmo_at = add_emacs_time (current_emacs_time (), tmo);
8730 while (pending_event_wait.eventtype)
8732 pending_signals = 1;
8733 totally_unblock_input ();
8734 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
8735 block_input ();
8736 interrupt_input_blocked = level;
8738 FD_ZERO (&fds);
8739 FD_SET (fd, &fds);
8741 time_now = current_emacs_time ();
8742 if (EMACS_TIME_LT (tmo_at, time_now))
8743 break;
8745 tmo = sub_emacs_time (tmo_at, time_now);
8746 if (pselect (fd + 1, &fds, NULL, NULL, &tmo, NULL) == 0)
8747 break; /* Timeout */
8749 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
8750 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
8754 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8755 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8756 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8757 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8759 static void
8760 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8762 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8764 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8765 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8766 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8768 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
8770 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8772 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols)
8773 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f);
8774 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows)
8775 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8777 if (change_gravity) f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8778 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8779 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8780 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8783 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8784 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8785 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8786 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8787 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8789 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8790 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8791 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8792 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8794 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8795 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8796 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8797 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8798 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8800 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8801 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8803 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
8804 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
8805 for the ConfigureNotify. */
8806 if (f->async_visible)
8807 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify);
8808 else
8810 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8811 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8812 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8813 x_sync (f);
8818 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8819 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8820 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8821 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8823 void
8824 x_set_window_size (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8826 block_input ();
8828 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8830 int r, c;
8832 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
8833 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
8834 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/cols to
8835 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
8836 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
8837 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
8838 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
8839 int pixelh = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8840 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8841 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
8842 is however. */
8843 pixelh -= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8844 #endif
8845 r = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, pixelh);
8846 /* Update f->scroll_bar_actual_width because it is used in
8847 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS. */
8848 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8849 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8850 c = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f));
8851 change_frame_size (f, r, c, 0, 1, 0);
8854 #ifdef USE_GTK
8855 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8856 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8857 else
8858 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8859 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8861 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8863 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8865 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8866 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8868 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8869 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8870 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8871 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8872 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8874 unblock_input ();
8877 /* Mouse warping. */
8879 void
8880 x_set_mouse_position (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
8882 int pix_x, pix_y;
8884 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8885 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8887 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8888 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8890 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8891 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8893 block_input ();
8895 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8896 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8897 unblock_input ();
8900 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8902 void
8903 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame *f, int pix_x, int pix_y)
8905 block_input ();
8907 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8908 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8909 unblock_input ();
8912 /* Raise frame F. */
8914 void
8915 x_raise_frame (struct frame *f)
8917 block_input ();
8918 if (f->async_visible)
8919 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8921 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8922 unblock_input ();
8925 /* Lower frame F. */
8927 static void
8928 x_lower_frame (struct frame *f)
8930 if (f->async_visible)
8932 block_input ();
8933 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8934 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8935 unblock_input ();
8939 /* Request focus with XEmbed */
8941 void
8942 xembed_request_focus (FRAME_PTR f)
8944 /* See XEmbed Protocol Specification at
8945 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/xembed-spec */
8946 if (f->async_visible)
8947 xembed_send_message (f, CurrentTime,
8948 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
8951 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
8953 void
8954 x_ewmh_activate_frame (FRAME_PTR f)
8956 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8957 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
8959 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8960 if (f->async_visible && wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window))
8962 Lisp_Object frame;
8963 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8964 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8965 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window,
8966 make_number (32),
8967 Fcons (make_number (1),
8968 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time),
8969 Qnil)));
8973 static void
8974 XTframe_raise_lower (FRAME_PTR f, int raise_flag)
8976 if (raise_flag)
8977 x_raise_frame (f);
8978 else
8979 x_lower_frame (f);
8982 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8984 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK
8986 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8988 #define XEMBED_VERSION 0
8990 static void
8991 xembed_set_info (struct frame *f, enum xembed_info flags)
8993 unsigned long data[2];
8994 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8996 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
8997 data[1] = flags;
8999 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9000 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO, dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO,
9001 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
9003 #endif /* defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK */
9005 static void
9006 xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time t, enum xembed_message msg,
9007 long int detail, long int data1, long int data2)
9009 XEvent event;
9011 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9012 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
9013 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
9014 event.xclient.format = 32;
9015 event.xclient.data.l[0] = t;
9016 event.xclient.data.l[1] = msg;
9017 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
9018 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
9019 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
9021 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
9022 False, NoEventMask, &event);
9023 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9026 /* Change of visibility. */
9028 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
9029 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
9030 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
9031 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
9032 but it will become visible later when the window manager
9033 finishes with it. */
9035 void
9036 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame *f)
9038 Lisp_Object type;
9039 int original_top, original_left;
9040 int retry_count = 2;
9042 retry:
9044 block_input ();
9046 type = x_icon_type (f);
9047 if (!NILP (type))
9048 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9050 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9052 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9053 call x_set_offset a second time
9054 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9055 before the window gets really visible. */
9056 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9057 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9058 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
9059 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9061 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
9063 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9064 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
9065 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9066 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9067 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9068 else
9070 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9071 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9073 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9074 #ifdef USE_GTK
9075 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9076 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9077 #else
9078 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9079 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9080 else
9081 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9082 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9083 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9086 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9088 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9089 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9090 so that incoming events are handled. */
9092 Lisp_Object frame;
9093 int count;
9094 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9095 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9096 will set it when they are handled. */
9097 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
9099 original_left = f->left_pos;
9100 original_top = f->top_pos;
9102 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9103 unblock_input ();
9105 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9107 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9108 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9109 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9110 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9112 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9113 because the window manager may choose the position
9114 and we don't want to override it. */
9116 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9117 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9118 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9119 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
9120 && previously_visible)
9122 Drawable rootw;
9123 int x, y;
9124 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
9126 block_input ();
9128 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9129 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9130 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9131 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9132 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9133 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9134 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9135 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9136 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
9138 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9139 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9140 original_left, original_top);
9142 unblock_input ();
9145 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9147 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9148 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9149 MapNotify at all.. */
9150 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9151 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9153 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9154 x_sync (f);
9156 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9157 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9158 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9159 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9160 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9161 probably a bug. */
9162 if (input_polling_used ())
9164 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9165 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9166 handler reset it. */
9167 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9168 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9169 poll_for_input_1 ();
9170 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9173 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9174 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9177 /* 2000-09-28: In
9179 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9180 (iconify-frame f)
9181 (raise-frame f))
9183 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9184 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9185 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9186 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9188 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count != 0)
9189 goto retry;
9193 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9195 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9197 void
9198 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame *f)
9200 Window window;
9202 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9203 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9205 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9206 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9207 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9209 block_input ();
9211 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9212 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9213 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9214 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9215 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9216 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9218 #ifdef USE_GTK
9219 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9220 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9221 else
9222 #else
9223 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9224 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9225 else
9226 #endif
9229 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9230 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9232 unblock_input ();
9233 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9237 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9238 just by the event that we get from the server.
9239 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9240 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9241 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9242 f->visible = 0;
9243 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
9244 f->async_visible = 0;
9245 f->async_iconified = 0;
9247 x_sync (f);
9249 unblock_input ();
9252 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9254 void
9255 x_iconify_frame (struct frame *f)
9257 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9258 int result;
9259 #endif
9260 Lisp_Object type;
9262 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9263 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9264 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9266 if (f->async_iconified)
9267 return;
9269 block_input ();
9271 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9273 type = x_icon_type (f);
9274 if (!NILP (type))
9275 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9277 #if defined (USE_GTK)
9278 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9280 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9281 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9283 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9284 f->iconified = 1;
9285 f->visible = 1;
9286 f->async_iconified = 1;
9287 f->async_visible = 0;
9288 unblock_input ();
9289 return;
9291 #endif
9293 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9295 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9297 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9298 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9299 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9300 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9301 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9302 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9303 so we have to record it here. */
9304 f->iconified = 1;
9305 f->visible = 1;
9306 f->async_iconified = 1;
9307 f->async_visible = 0;
9308 unblock_input ();
9309 return;
9312 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9313 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9314 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9315 unblock_input ();
9317 if (!result)
9318 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9320 f->async_iconified = 1;
9321 f->async_visible = 0;
9324 block_input ();
9325 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9326 unblock_input ();
9327 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9329 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9330 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9331 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9332 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9333 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9334 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9336 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9337 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9339 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9340 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9342 XEvent msg;
9344 msg.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9345 msg.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9346 msg.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9347 msg.xclient.format = 32;
9348 msg.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9350 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9351 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9352 False,
9353 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9354 &msg))
9356 unblock_input ();
9357 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9361 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9362 IconicState. */
9363 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9365 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9367 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9368 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9371 f->async_iconified = 1;
9372 f->async_visible = 0;
9374 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9375 unblock_input ();
9376 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9380 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9382 void
9383 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame *f)
9385 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9386 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9387 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9388 Lisp_Object bar;
9389 struct scroll_bar *b;
9390 #endif
9392 block_input ();
9394 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9395 commands to the X server. */
9396 if (dpyinfo->display)
9398 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9399 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9400 face. */
9401 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9402 free_frame_faces (f);
9404 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9405 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9407 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9408 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9409 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9410 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9411 toolkit scroll bars. */
9412 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9414 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9415 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9417 #endif
9419 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9420 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9421 free_frame_xic (f);
9422 #endif
9424 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9425 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9427 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9428 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9430 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9431 we are using a toolkit. */
9432 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9433 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9435 free_frame_menubar (f);
9436 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9438 #ifdef USE_GTK
9439 xg_free_frame_widgets (f);
9440 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9442 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9443 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9444 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9446 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9447 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9448 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9449 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9450 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9451 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9453 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9454 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9455 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9456 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9457 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9458 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9459 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9460 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9461 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9462 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9463 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9464 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9465 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9466 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9467 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9469 x_free_gcs (f);
9470 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9473 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9474 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9475 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9477 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9478 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9479 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9480 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9481 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9482 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9484 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9486 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9487 = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9488 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9489 = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9490 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9491 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9494 unblock_input ();
9498 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9500 static void
9501 x_destroy_window (struct frame *f)
9503 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9505 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9506 commands to the X server. */
9507 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9508 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9510 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9514 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9516 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9517 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9518 that the window now has.
9519 If USER_POSITION, set the USPosition
9520 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9521 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c. */
9523 #ifndef USE_GTK
9524 void
9525 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame *f, long flags, bool user_position)
9527 XSizeHints size_hints;
9528 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9530 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9531 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9533 widget_update_wm_size_hints (f->output_data.x->widget);
9534 return;
9536 #endif
9538 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9539 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9541 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9542 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9544 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9545 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9547 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9548 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9549 size_hints.max_width = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9550 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9551 size_hints.max_height = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9552 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9554 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
9556 int base_width, base_height;
9557 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9559 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9560 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9562 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9564 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9565 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9566 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9567 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9568 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9570 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9571 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9572 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9574 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9575 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9576 size_hints.base_height = base_height + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
9577 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9578 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9581 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9582 if (flags)
9584 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9585 goto no_read;
9589 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9590 long supplied_return;
9591 int value;
9593 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9594 &supplied_return);
9596 if (flags)
9597 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9598 else
9600 if (value == 0)
9601 hints.flags = 0;
9602 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9603 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9604 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9605 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9606 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9607 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9608 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9609 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9613 no_read:
9615 #ifdef PWinGravity
9616 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9617 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9619 if (user_position)
9621 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9622 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9624 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9626 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9628 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9630 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9632 static void
9633 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *f, int state)
9635 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9636 Arg al[1];
9638 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9639 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9640 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9641 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9643 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9644 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9646 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9647 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9650 static void
9651 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *f, ptrdiff_t pixmap_id)
9653 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9655 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
9656 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9657 #endif
9659 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9661 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9662 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9663 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9664 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9666 else
9668 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
9669 pixmap. */
9670 return;
9674 #ifdef USE_GTK
9676 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9677 return;
9680 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9683 Arg al[1];
9684 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9685 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9686 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9687 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9690 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9692 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9693 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9695 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9698 void
9699 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame *f, int icon_x, int icon_y)
9701 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9703 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9704 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9705 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9707 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9711 /***********************************************************************
9712 Fonts
9713 ***********************************************************************/
9715 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
9717 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9718 font table. */
9720 static void
9721 x_check_font (struct frame *f, struct font *font)
9723 eassert (font != NULL && ! NILP (font->props[FONT_TYPE_INDEX]));
9724 if (font->driver->check)
9725 eassert (font->driver->check (f, font) == 0);
9728 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
9731 /***********************************************************************
9732 Initialization
9733 ***********************************************************************/
9735 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9736 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9737 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9738 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9740 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9741 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9742 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9744 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9745 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9746 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9747 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9748 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9749 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9750 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9753 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
9755 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
9757 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9759 static int x_initialized;
9761 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9762 the screen number from the server number. */
9763 static int
9764 same_x_server (const char *name1, const char *name2)
9766 int seen_colon = 0;
9767 const char *system_name = SSDATA (Vsystem_name);
9768 ptrdiff_t system_name_length = SBYTES (Vsystem_name);
9769 ptrdiff_t length_until_period = 0;
9771 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
9772 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
9773 length_until_period++;
9775 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
9776 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
9777 name1 += 4;
9778 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
9779 name2 += 4;
9780 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
9781 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
9782 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
9783 name1 += system_name_length;
9784 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
9785 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
9786 name2 += system_name_length;
9787 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
9788 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
9789 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
9790 name1 += length_until_period;
9791 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
9792 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
9793 name2 += length_until_period;
9795 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
9797 if (*name1 == ':')
9798 seen_colon = 1;
9799 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
9800 return 1;
9802 return (seen_colon
9803 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
9804 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
9807 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
9808 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
9809 to 5. */
9810 static void
9811 get_bits_and_offset (long unsigned int mask, int *bits, int *offset)
9813 int nr = 0;
9814 int off = 0;
9816 while (!(mask & 1))
9818 off++;
9819 mask >>= 1;
9822 while (mask & 1)
9824 nr++;
9825 mask >>= 1;
9828 *offset = off;
9829 *bits = nr;
9832 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
9833 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
9836 x_display_ok (const char *display)
9838 int dpy_ok = 1;
9839 Display *dpy;
9841 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
9842 if (dpy)
9843 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
9844 else
9845 dpy_ok = 0;
9846 return dpy_ok;
9849 #ifdef USE_GTK
9850 static void
9851 my_log_handler (const gchar *log_domain, GLogLevelFlags log_level,
9852 const gchar *msg, gpointer user_data)
9854 if (!strstr (msg, "g_set_prgname"))
9855 fprintf (stderr, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain, msg);
9857 #endif
9859 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
9860 the structure that describes the open display.
9861 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
9863 struct x_display_info *
9864 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name, char *xrm_option, char *resource_name)
9866 int connection;
9867 Display *dpy;
9868 struct terminal *terminal;
9869 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9870 XrmDatabase xrdb;
9871 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo;
9872 ptrdiff_t lim;
9874 block_input ();
9876 if (!x_initialized)
9878 x_initialize ();
9879 ++x_initialized;
9882 if (! x_display_ok (SSDATA (display_name)))
9883 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SSDATA (display_name));
9885 #ifdef USE_GTK
9887 #define NUM_ARGV 10
9888 int argc;
9889 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
9890 char **argv2 = argv;
9891 guint id;
9893 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
9895 xg_display_open (SSDATA (display_name), &dpy);
9897 else
9899 static char display_opt[] = "--display";
9900 static char name_opt[] = "--name";
9902 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
9903 argv[argc] = 0;
9905 argc = 0;
9906 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
9908 if (! NILP (display_name))
9910 argv[argc++] = display_opt;
9911 argv[argc++] = SSDATA (display_name);
9914 argv[argc++] = name_opt;
9915 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
9917 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9919 /* Emacs can only handle core input events, so make sure
9920 Gtk doesn't use Xinput or Xinput2 extensions. */
9921 xputenv ("GDK_CORE_DEVICE_EVENTS=1");
9923 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
9924 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
9925 id = g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING | G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
9926 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION, my_log_handler, NULL);
9927 #ifdef HAVE_CLUTTER
9928 gtk_clutter_init (&argc, &argv2);
9929 #else
9931 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function.
9932 Call before gtk_init so Gtk+ event filters comes after our. */
9933 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
9935 /* gtk_init does set_locale. Fix locale before and after. */
9936 fixup_locale ();
9937 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
9938 #endif
9939 fixup_locale ();
9941 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id);
9943 xg_initialize ();
9945 dpy = DEFAULT_GDK_DISPLAY ();
9947 #if GTK_MAJOR_VERSION <= 2 && GTK_MINOR_VERSION <= 90
9948 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
9950 const char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
9951 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
9953 s = build_string (file);
9954 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
9956 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
9957 gtk_rc_parse (SSDATA (abs_file));
9959 #endif
9961 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
9962 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
9965 #else /* not USE_GTK */
9966 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9967 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
9968 errors with X11R5:
9969 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
9970 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
9971 So let's not use it until R6. */
9972 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9973 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
9974 #endif
9977 int argc = 0;
9978 char *argv[3];
9980 argv[0] = "";
9981 argc = 1;
9982 if (xrm_option)
9984 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
9985 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
9987 turn_on_atimers (0);
9988 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SSDATA (display_name),
9989 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
9990 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
9991 &argc, argv);
9992 turn_on_atimers (1);
9994 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9995 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
9996 fixup_locale ();
9997 #endif
10000 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10001 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10002 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SSDATA (display_name));
10003 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10004 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10006 /* Detect failure. */
10007 if (dpy == 0)
10009 unblock_input ();
10010 return 0;
10013 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10015 dpyinfo = xzalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo);
10016 hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
10018 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
10021 struct x_display_info *share;
10022 Lisp_Object tail;
10024 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10025 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10026 if (same_x_server (SSDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10027 SSDATA (display_name)))
10028 break;
10029 if (share)
10030 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
10031 else
10033 terminal->kboard = xmalloc (sizeof *terminal->kboard);
10034 init_kboard (terminal->kboard);
10035 kset_window_system (terminal->kboard, Qx);
10037 /* Add the keyboard to the list before running Lisp code (via
10038 Qvendor_specific_keysyms below), since these are not traced
10039 via terminals but only through all_kboards. */
10040 terminal->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10041 all_kboards = terminal->kboard;
10043 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10045 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10047 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
10048 list of terminals. */
10049 struct gcpro gcpro1;
10050 Lisp_Object gcpro_term;
10051 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term, terminal);
10052 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term);
10054 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
10055 terminal_list = terminal->next_terminal;
10056 unblock_input ();
10057 kset_system_key_alist
10058 (terminal->kboard,
10059 call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10060 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string));
10061 block_input ();
10062 terminal->next_terminal = terminal_list;
10063 terminal_list = terminal;
10064 UNGCPRO;
10067 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10068 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10069 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10070 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10071 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
10073 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
10076 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10077 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10078 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10080 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10081 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10082 x_display_name_list);
10083 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10085 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10087 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10088 terminal->name = xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name) + 1);
10089 memcpy (terminal->name, SSDATA (display_name), SBYTES (display_name));
10090 terminal->name[SBYTES (display_name)] = 0;
10092 #if 0
10093 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10094 #endif /* ! 0 */
10096 lim = min (PTRDIFF_MAX, SIZE_MAX) - sizeof "@";
10097 if (lim - SBYTES (Vinvocation_name) < SBYTES (Vsystem_name))
10098 memory_full (SIZE_MAX);
10099 dpyinfo->x_id_name = xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10100 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name) + 2);
10101 strcat (strcat (strcpy (dpyinfo->x_id_name, SSDATA (Vinvocation_name)), "@"),
10102 SSDATA (Vsystem_name));
10104 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10105 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10107 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10108 #ifdef USE_GTK
10109 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10110 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10111 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10113 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10114 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10116 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10117 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10118 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10119 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10120 #else
10121 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10122 #endif
10123 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10124 all versions. */
10125 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10127 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10128 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10129 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10130 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10131 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10132 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10133 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10134 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10135 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10136 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10137 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10138 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10139 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10140 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10141 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10142 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10143 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10144 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10145 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10146 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10147 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10148 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10149 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10150 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10151 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10152 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10153 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10155 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10156 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10157 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10159 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10161 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10162 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10163 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10164 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10165 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10166 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10169 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10170 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10172 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10174 Lisp_Object value;
10175 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10176 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10177 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10178 Qnil, Qnil);
10179 if (STRINGP (value)
10180 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10181 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10182 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10185 else
10186 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10187 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10189 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
10191 /* If we are using Xft, check dpi value in X resources.
10192 It is better we use it as well, since Xft will use it, as will all
10193 Gnome applications. If our real DPI is smaller or larger than the
10194 one Xft uses, our font will look smaller or larger than other
10195 for other applications, even if it is the same font name (monospace-10
10196 for example). */
10197 char *v = XGetDefault (dpyinfo->display, "Xft", "dpi");
10198 double d;
10199 if (v != NULL && sscanf (v, "%lf", &d) == 1)
10200 dpyinfo->resy = dpyinfo->resx = d;
10202 #endif
10204 if (dpyinfo->resy < 1)
10206 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10207 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10208 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10209 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10210 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10211 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10212 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10213 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10214 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10218 const struct
10220 const char *name;
10221 Atom *atom;
10222 } atom_refs[] = {
10223 { "WM_PROTOCOLS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols },
10224 { "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus },
10225 { "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself },
10226 { "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window },
10227 { "WM_CHANGE_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state },
10228 { "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied },
10229 { "WM_MOVED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved },
10230 { "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader },
10231 { "Editres", &dpyinfo->Xatom_editres },
10232 { "CLIPBOARD", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD },
10233 { "TIMESTAMP", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP },
10234 { "TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT },
10235 { "COMPOUND_TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT },
10236 { "UTF8_STRING", &dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING },
10237 { "DELETE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE },
10238 { "MULTIPLE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE },
10239 { "INCR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR },
10240 { "_EMACS_TMP_", &dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP },
10241 { "TARGETS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS },
10242 { "NULL", &dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL },
10243 { "ATOM", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM },
10244 { "ATOM_PAIR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR },
10245 { "CLIPBOARD_MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD_MANAGER },
10246 { "_XEMBED_INFO", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO },
10247 /* For properties of font. */
10248 { "PIXEL_SIZE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE },
10249 { "AVERAGE_WIDTH", &dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH },
10250 { "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET },
10251 { "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE },
10252 { "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT },
10253 /* Ghostscript support. */
10254 { "DONE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE },
10255 { "PAGE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE },
10256 { "SCROLLBAR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar },
10257 { "_XEMBED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED },
10258 /* EWMH */
10259 { "_NET_WM_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state },
10260 { "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen },
10261 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ",
10262 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz },
10263 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT",
10264 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert },
10265 { "_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky },
10266 { "_NET_WM_STATE_HIDDEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden },
10267 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type },
10268 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP",
10269 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip },
10270 { "_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_icon_name },
10271 { "_NET_WM_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_name },
10272 { "_NET_SUPPORTED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported },
10273 { "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check },
10274 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity },
10275 { "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window },
10276 { "_NET_FRAME_EXTENTS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_frame_extents },
10277 /* Session management */
10278 { "SM_CLIENT_ID", &dpyinfo->Xatom_SM_CLIENT_ID },
10279 { "_XSETTINGS_SETTINGS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_prop },
10280 { "MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_mgr },
10283 int i;
10284 const int atom_count = sizeof (atom_refs) / sizeof (atom_refs[0]);
10285 /* 1 for _XSETTINGS_SN */
10286 const int total_atom_count = 1 + atom_count;
10287 Atom *atoms_return = xmalloc (total_atom_count * sizeof *atoms_return);
10288 char **atom_names = xmalloc (total_atom_count * sizeof *atom_names);
10289 static char const xsettings_fmt[] = "_XSETTINGS_S%d";
10290 char xsettings_atom_name[sizeof xsettings_fmt - 2
10291 + INT_STRLEN_BOUND (int)];
10293 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10294 atom_names[i] = (char *) atom_refs[i].name;
10296 /* Build _XSETTINGS_SN atom name */
10297 sprintf (xsettings_atom_name, xsettings_fmt,
10298 XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen));
10299 atom_names[i] = xsettings_atom_name;
10301 XInternAtoms (dpyinfo->display, atom_names, total_atom_count,
10302 False, atoms_return);
10304 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10305 *atom_refs[i].atom = atoms_return[i];
10307 /* Manual copy of last atom */
10308 dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_sel = atoms_return[i];
10310 xfree (atom_names);
10311 xfree (atoms_return);
10314 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10315 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10316 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms
10317 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10319 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
10320 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
10321 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
10323 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10324 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10325 dpyinfo->gray
10326 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10327 gray_bits, gray_width, gray_height,
10328 1, 0, 1);
10330 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10331 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10332 #endif
10334 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo);
10336 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10337 if (connection != 0)
10338 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10340 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10341 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10342 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10344 if (interrupt_input)
10345 init_sigio (connection);
10347 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10349 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10350 Font font;
10352 dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10353 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10354 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10355 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10356 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10357 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10358 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10359 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10360 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10361 emacs_abort ();
10362 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10363 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10364 x_uncatch_errors ();
10366 #endif
10368 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10369 for debugging X code. */
10371 Lisp_Object value;
10372 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10373 build_string ("synchronous"),
10374 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10375 Qnil, Qnil);
10376 if (STRINGP (value)
10377 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10378 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10379 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10383 Lisp_Object value;
10384 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10385 build_string ("useXIM"),
10386 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10387 Qnil, Qnil);
10388 #ifdef USE_XIM
10389 if (STRINGP (value)
10390 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "false")
10391 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "off")))
10392 use_xim = 0;
10393 #else
10394 if (STRINGP (value)
10395 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10396 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10397 use_xim = 1;
10398 #endif
10401 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10402 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
10403 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
10404 tty. */
10405 if (terminal->id == 1)
10406 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10407 #endif
10409 unblock_input ();
10411 return dpyinfo;
10414 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
10415 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10417 static void
10418 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10420 struct terminal *t;
10422 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
10423 X display. */
10424 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
10425 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
10427 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10428 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
10429 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
10430 x_session_close ();
10431 #endif
10432 delete_terminal (t);
10433 break;
10436 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10438 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10439 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10440 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10441 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10442 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10443 else
10445 Lisp_Object tail;
10447 tail = x_display_name_list;
10448 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10450 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10452 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10453 break;
10455 tail = XCDR (tail);
10459 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10460 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10462 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10463 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10464 else
10466 struct x_display_info *tail;
10468 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10469 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10470 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10473 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10474 xfree (dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms);
10475 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10476 xfree (dpyinfo);
10479 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10481 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10482 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10483 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10484 that slows us down. */
10486 static void
10487 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer *timer)
10489 block_input ();
10490 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
10491 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10493 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10494 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10495 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10496 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10498 unblock_input ();
10501 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10502 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10503 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10504 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10505 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10506 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10507 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10509 void
10510 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
10512 block_input ();
10513 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
10515 EMACS_TIME interval = make_emacs_time (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
10516 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10517 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
10519 unblock_input ();
10522 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10525 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10527 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10529 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10530 x_produce_glyphs,
10531 x_write_glyphs,
10532 x_insert_glyphs,
10533 x_clear_end_of_line,
10534 x_scroll_run,
10535 x_after_update_window_line,
10536 x_update_window_begin,
10537 x_update_window_end,
10538 x_cursor_to,
10539 x_flush,
10540 #ifdef XFlush
10541 x_flush,
10542 #else
10543 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10544 #endif
10545 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10546 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10547 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10548 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10549 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10550 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10551 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10552 x_draw_glyph_string,
10553 x_define_frame_cursor,
10554 x_clear_frame_area,
10555 x_draw_window_cursor,
10556 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10557 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10561 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
10562 void
10563 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
10565 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
10567 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
10568 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
10569 if (!terminal->name)
10570 return;
10572 block_input ();
10573 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10574 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
10575 X display. */
10576 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10577 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10578 #endif
10580 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
10581 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
10582 if (dpyinfo->display)
10584 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
10585 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
10587 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
10588 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
10589 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
10590 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
10592 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
10593 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
10594 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
10595 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
10596 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
10597 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
10598 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
10599 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
10600 leaks in other situations. */
10601 #if 0
10602 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10603 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, NULL);
10604 #else
10605 dpyinfo->display->db = NULL;
10606 #endif
10607 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
10608 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
10609 closing all the displays. */
10610 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10611 #endif
10613 #ifdef USE_GTK
10614 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
10615 #else
10616 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10617 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10618 #else
10619 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10620 #endif
10621 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
10624 /* Mark as dead. */
10625 dpyinfo->display = NULL;
10626 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
10627 unblock_input ();
10630 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
10631 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
10633 static struct terminal *
10634 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10636 struct terminal *terminal;
10638 terminal = create_terminal ();
10640 terminal->type = output_x_window;
10641 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
10642 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
10644 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
10646 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10647 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10648 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10649 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10650 terminal->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook = XTtoggle_invisible_pointer;
10651 terminal->reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10652 terminal->set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10653 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10654 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10655 terminal->set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10656 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10657 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10658 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10659 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10660 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10661 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
10662 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10663 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10664 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10665 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10667 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
10668 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
10670 terminal->rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10671 terminal->scroll_region_ok = 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
10672 terminal->char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10673 terminal->line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
10674 terminal->fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well. */
10675 terminal->memory_below_frame = 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
10676 off the bottom. */
10678 return terminal;
10681 void
10682 x_initialize (void)
10684 baud_rate = 19200;
10686 x_noop_count = 0;
10687 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10688 any_help_event_p = 0;
10689 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10691 #ifdef USE_GTK
10692 current_count = -1;
10693 #endif
10695 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10696 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
10698 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10699 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10701 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10703 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10704 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10705 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10706 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10707 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10708 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10709 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10711 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10712 #endif
10714 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10715 #ifndef USE_GTK
10716 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10717 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10718 #endif
10719 #endif
10721 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
10722 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
10723 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
10725 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10726 original error handler. */
10727 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10728 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10732 void
10733 syms_of_xterm (void)
10735 x_error_message = NULL;
10737 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10738 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10740 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10741 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10743 DEFSYM (Qvendor_specific_keysyms, "vendor-specific-keysyms");
10744 DEFSYM (Qlatin_1, "latin-1");
10746 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10747 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10749 #ifdef USE_GTK
10750 xg_default_icon_file = build_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
10751 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file);
10753 DEFSYM (Qx_gtk_map_stock, "x-gtk-map-stock");
10754 #endif
10756 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10757 x_use_underline_position_properties,
10758 doc: /* Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10759 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10760 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10761 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
10762 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
10763 sizes. */);
10764 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10766 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
10767 x_underline_at_descent_line,
10768 doc: /* Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
10769 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
10770 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
10771 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
10772 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
10774 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10775 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10776 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10777 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10778 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10779 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10780 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10781 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10782 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10784 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10785 doc: /* Which toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses, if any.
10786 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use toolkit scroll bars.
10787 With the X Window system, the value is a symbol describing the
10788 X toolkit. Possible values are: gtk, motif, xaw, or xaw3d.
10789 With MS Windows or Nextstep, the value is t. */);
10790 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10791 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10792 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("motif");
10793 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10794 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
10795 #elif USE_GTK
10796 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("gtk");
10797 #else
10798 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw");
10799 #endif
10800 #else
10801 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10802 #endif
10804 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10805 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10807 Qmodifier_value = intern_c_string ("modifier-value");
10808 Qalt = intern_c_string ("alt");
10809 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10810 Qhyper = intern_c_string ("hyper");
10811 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10812 Qmeta = intern_c_string ("meta");
10813 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10814 Qsuper = intern_c_string ("super");
10815 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10817 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", Vx_alt_keysym,
10818 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10819 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10820 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10821 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10822 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10824 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", Vx_hyper_keysym,
10825 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10826 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10827 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10828 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10829 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10831 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", Vx_meta_keysym,
10832 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10833 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10834 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10835 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10836 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10838 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", Vx_super_keysym,
10839 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10840 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10841 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10842 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10843 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10845 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", Vx_keysym_table,
10846 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10847 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (hashtest_eql, make_number (900),
10848 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10849 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10850 Qnil);
10853 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */